TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf•...

315
TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Series External Equipment Interface Specification First Edition: February 21, 2005 Second Edition: Third Edition: July 27, 2005

Transcript of TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf•...

Page 1: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer

B-SA4T Series External Equipment Interface Specification

First Edition: February 21, 2005 Second Edition: Third Edition: July 27, 2005

Page 2: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Page

1. SCOPE ....................................................................................................................................... 1

2. GENERAL DESCRIPTION......................................................................................................... 1

3. INTERFACE ............................................................................................................................... 2

3.1 SERIAL INTERFACE............................................................................................................. 2 3.2 PARALLEL INTERFACE ....................................................................................................... 7 3.3 USB INTERFACE.................................................................................................................. 16 3.4 NETWORK INTERFACE....................................................................................................... 16

4. KEY OPERATION FUNCTIONS................................................................................................ 17

4.1 SYSTEM MODE FUNCTIONS.............................................................................................. 17 4.2 ONLINE MODE FUNCTIONS ............................................................................................... 21 4.3 DOWNLOAD MODE SETTING FUNCTION ......................................................................... 21

5. TRANSMISSION SEQUENCE................................................................................................... 22

5.1 INITIALIZATION .................................................................................................................... 22 5.2 LABEL ISSUE OPERATION ................................................................................................. 24

6. INTERFACE COMMANDS......................................................................................................... 26

6.1 OUTLINE OF COMMANDS................................................................................................... 26 6.2 LIST OF COMMANDS........................................................................................................... 27 6.3 COMMANDS FOR CREATING APPLICATION.................................................................... 29

6.3.1 LABEL SIZE SET COMMAND ......................................................................................... 29 6.3.2 POSITION FINE ADJUST COMMAND............................................................................ 33 6.3.3 PRINT DENSITY FINE ADJUST COMMAND.................................................................. 38 6.3.4 RIBBON MOTOR DRIVE VOLTAGE FINE ADJUST COMMAND................................... 39 6.3.5 IMAGE BUFFER CLEAR COMMAND ............................................................................. 40 6.3.6 CLEAR AREA COMMAND............................................................................................... 41 6.3.7 LINE FORMAT COMMAND ............................................................................................. 43 6.3.8 BIT MAP FONT FORMAT COMMAND............................................................................ 49 6.3.9 OUTLINE FONT FORMAT COMMAND........................................................................... 63 6.3.10 BAR CODE FORMAT COMMAND .................................................................................. 79 6.3.11 BIT MAP FONT DATA COMMAND.................................................................................. 119 6.3.12 OUTLINE FONT DATA COMMAND ................................................................................ 123 6.3.13 BAR CODE DATA COMMAND ........................................................................................ 126 6.3.14 ISSUE COMMAND........................................................................................................... 139 6.3.15 FEED COMMAND............................................................................................................ 152 6.3.16 EJECT COMMAND .......................................................................................................... 158 6.3.17 FORWARD/REVERSE FEED COMMAND...................................................................... 159 6.3.18 STORAGE AREA ALLOCATE COMMAND ..................................................................... 161 6.3.19 FLASH MEMORY FORMAT COMMAND ........................................................................ 163 6.3.20 2-BYTE WRITABLE CHARACTER CODE RANGE COMMAND .................................... 164

i

Page 3: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Page

6.3.21 BIT MAP WRITABLE CHARACTER COMMAND ([ESC] XD) ......................................... 165 6.3.22 GRAPHIC COMMAND ..................................................................................................... 174 6.3.23 SAVE START COMMAND ([ESC] XO) ............................................................................ 183 6.3.24 SAVE TERMINATE COMMAND ...................................................................................... 184 6.3.25 SAVED DATA CALL COMMAND ([ESC] XQ) ................................................................. 185 6.3.26 HEAD BROKEN DOTS CHECK COMMAND .................................................................. 186 6.3.27 MESSAGE DISPLAY COMMAND ................................................................................... 187 6.3.28 RESET COMMAND.......................................................................................................... 189 6.3.29 STATUS REQUEST COMMAND..................................................................................... 190 6.3.30 RECEIVE BUFFER FREE SPACE REQUEST COMMAND............................................ 191 6.3.31 VERSION INFORMATION ACQUIRE COMMAND ......................................................... 192 6.3.32 PRINTER OPTION STATUS ACQUIRE COMMAND...................................................... 193 6.3.33 IP ADDRESS SET COMMAND........................................................................................ 194 6.3.34 SOCKET COMMUNICATION PORT SET COMMAND ................................................... 195 6.3.35 DHCP FUNCTION SET COMMAND................................................................................ 196 6.3.36 PASS-THROUGH COMMAND ........................................................................................ 197 6.3.37 INTERNAL SERIAL INTERFACE PARAMETER SET COMMAND................................. 198

6.4 COMMANDS FOR SYSTEM ADMINISTRATOR.................................................................. 199 6.4.1 PARAMETER SET COMMAND ....................................................................................... 199 6.4.2 FINE ADJUSTMENT VALUE SET COMMAND ............................................................... 203 6.4.3 RFID PARAMETER SET COMMAND.............................................................................. 205 6.4.4 BATCH RESET COMMAND ............................................................................................ 206

6.5 COMMANDS RELATED TO THE RFID................................................................................ 207 6.5.1 RFID TAG POSITION ADJUSTMENT COMMAND......................................................... 207 6.5.2 RFID TAG READ COMMAND.......................................................................................... 208 6.5.3 RFID VOID PATTERN PRINT COMMAND ..................................................................... 210

7. CONTROL CODE SELECTION................................................................................................. 211

8. ERROR PROCESSING.............................................................................................................. 212

8.1 COMMUNICATION ERRORS............................................................................................... 212 8.2 ERRORS IN ISSUING OR FEEDING ................................................................................... 212 8.3 ERRORS IN WRITABLE CHARACTER AND PC COMMAND SAVE MODES.................... 215 8.4 SYSTEM ERRORS................................................................................................................ 215 8.5 RESET PROCESSING.......................................................................................................... 215 8.6 RFID ERROR ........................................................................................................................ 216

9. STATUS RESPONSE ................................................................................................................ 217

9.1 FUNCTIONS.......................................................................................................................... 217 9.1.1 STATUS FORMAT ........................................................................................................... 218 9.1.2 DETAIL STATUS.............................................................................................................. 219 9.1.3 SUMMARY OF STATUS FORMAT.................................................................................. 221

9.2 PARALLEL INTERFACE SINGALS ...................................................................................... 222 9.2.1 COMPATIBILITY MODE .................................................................................................. 222

9.3 E-MAIL................................................................................................................................... 223

ii

Page 4: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Page

10. LCD MESSAGES AND LED INDICATIONS ............................................................................. 224 11. LCD MESSAGES IN DIFFERENT LANGUAGES (UPPER LINE OF LCD) ............................. 227 12. CHARACTER CODE TABLE .................................................................................................... 229

12.1 TIMES ROMAN, HELVETICA, LETTER GOTHIC, PRESTIGE ELITE, COURIER, GOTHIC725 BLACK....... 229 12.2 PRESENTATION................................................................................................................... 236 12.3 OCR-A ................................................................................................................................... 240 12.4 OCR-B ................................................................................................................................... 247 12.5 TEC OUTLINE FONT 1 ......................................................................................................... 253 12.6 PRICE FONT 1, 2, 3 .............................................................................................................. 260 12.7 TEC OUTLINE FONT 2, 3, GOTHIC725 BLACK.................................................................. 261 12.8 TrueType FONT..................................................................................................................... 268

13. BAR CODE TABLE.................................................................................................................... 275

14. DRAWING OF BAR CODE DATA............................................................................................. 289

15. AUTOMATIC ADDITION OF START/STOP CODES................................................................ 310

iii

Page 5: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 1 -

1. SCOPE

This specification applies to the external equipment interface for use with the B-SA4T series general-purpose bar code printer.

2. GENERAL DESCRIPTION

The external equipment interface connects the printer to the host computer through a serial interface (RS-232C/USB), parallel interface (Centronics), or a network for making various settings and printing labels.

This specification describes how to use the external equipment interface for the TPCL (TEC Printer Command Language).

The following table shows the system configuration.

Print head type 203 dpi 300 dpi

Flash ROM 16 MB × 1 = 16 MB

Whole 8 MB × 1 = 8 MB Memory

SDRAM Image buffer of whole SDRAM

0.8 MB (Label length: 999 mm)

1.8 MB (Label length: 999 mm)

Bit map Kanji (Gothic) Bit map Kanji (

Standard

RS-232C Option

Centronics Standard

USB Standard

100BASE LAN board Option

Cutter module Option

Strip module Option

Wireless LAN module Option

RFID module Option

Page 6: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 2 -

3. INTERFACE

3.1 SERIAL INTERFACE

(1) Type: Conforming to RS-232C

(2) Communication Mode: Full duplex

(3) Transmission Speed: 2400 bps 4800 bps 9600 bps 19200 bps 38400 bps 115200 bps

(4) Synchronization Method: Start-stop synchronization

(5) Start Bit: 1 bit

(6) Stop Bit: 1 bit 2 bits

(7) Data Length: 7 bits 8 bits

(8) Parity: None Even Odd

(9) Error Detection: Parity error Vertical parity error check Framing error This error occurs if no stop bit is found in the frame

specified starting with the start bit.

(10) Protocol: No-procedure method

(11) Data Input Code: ASCII code European character set 8 bit code Graphics 8 bit code

(12) Receive Buffer: 1 MB * The use of the receive buffer is shared between interfaces.

Page 7: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 3 -

(13) Flow Control: XON/XOFF (DC1/DC3) Protocol READY/BUSY (DTR) Protocol XON/XOFF (DC1/DC3) Protocol + READY/BUSY (DTR) Protocol READY/BUSY (RTS) Protocol

� XON/XOFF (DC1/DC3) Protocol

� When initialized after the power is turned on, this printer becomes ready to receive data and sends an XON code (11H). (Transmission or non-transmission of the XON code is selectable by means of the parameter setting.)

� The printer sends an XOFF code (13H) when the free space of the receive buffer becomes 10K bytes or less.

� The printer sends an XON code (11H) when the free space of the receive buffer becomes 512K bytes or more.

� After the receive buffer has become full, the printer discards data received, without storing it in the buffer. (After detecting the XOFF code, the host computer must stop transmission before the printer receive buffer becomes full.)

� The printer sends an XOFF code (13H) when the power is off. (Transmission or non-transmission of the XOFF code is selectable by means of the parameter setting.)

� The DTR signal is always “High” (READY).

� The RTS signal is always “High”.

� READY/BUSY (DTR) Protocol

� When initialized after the power is turned on, this printer becomes ready to receive data and turns the DTR signal to “High” level (READY).

� The printer turns the DTR signal to “Low” level (BUSY) when the free space of the receive buffer becomes 10K bytes or less.

� The printer turns the DTR signal to “High” level (READY) when the free space of the receive buffer become s 512K bytes or more.

� After the receive buffer has become full, the printer discards data received, without storing it in the buffer. (After detecting the BUSY signal, the host computer must stop transmission before the printer receive buffer becomes full.)

� The RTS signal is always “High”.

Page 8: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 4 -

� XON/XOFF (DC1/DC3) Protocol + READY/BUSY (DTR) Protocol

� When initialized after the power is turned on, this printer becomes ready to receive data and turns the DTR signal to “High” level (READY). The printer also sends an XON code (11H).

� When the free space of the receive buffer become s 10K bytes or less, the printer turns the DTR signal to “Low” level (BUSY) and sends an XOFF code (13H).

� When the free space of the receive buffer becomes 512K bytes or more, the printer turns the DTR signal to “High” level (READY) and sends an XON code (11H).

� After the receive buffer has become full, the printer discards data received, without storing it in the buffer. (After detecting the XOFF code or BUSY signal, the host computer must stop transmission before the printer receive buffer becomes full.)

� The printer sends an XOFF code (13H) when the power is off.

� The RTS signal is always “High”.

� READY/BUSY (RTS) Protocol

� When initialized after the power is turned on, this printer turns the RTS signal to “High” (READY).

� The printer turns the RTS signal to “Low” (BUSY) when the free space of the receive buffer becomes 10K bytes or less.

� The printer turns the RTS signal to “High” (READY) when the free space of the receive buffer becomes 512K bytes or more.

� After the receive buffer has become full, the printer discards data received, without storing it in the buffer. (After detecting the BUSY signal, the host computer must stop transmission before the printer receive buffer becomes full.)

� The DTR signal is always “High” (READY).

� The DSR signal from the host must always be “High”.

* When the flow control is performed with a Windows PC, “READY/BUSY (RTS) protocol” should be selected, and “Hardware” should be selected for the flow control in the Windows communication port setting.

NOTE: For “READY/BUSY (DTR) protocol”, data should be sent after 200 ms from when the DTR signal is turned to “High” (READY). For “READY/BUSY (RTS) protocol”, data should be sent after 200 ms from when the RTS signal is turned to “High” (READY).

Page 9: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 5 -

(14) Input/Output Signals

(15) Connector Pin Assignment and Signal Description

Pin No. Signal Name

Function Signal Direction

1 FG • Ground line for circuit protection 2 RD • Line for data which the printer receives from the host.

• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark) state when no transmission is in

progress.

← Host

3 TD • Line for data which the printer sends to the host. • Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark) state when no transmission is in

progress.

Printer →

4 CTS • It is an input signal indicating whether or not the data transmission to the host is possible. However, this printer does not detect this signal.

← Host

5 RTS • Output signal to the host. For the READY/BUSY (RTS) protocol: • It indicates the ready state for the received data. • It is at “Low” when the receive buffer is nearly full, and at

“High” when nearly empty. For protocol other than the READY/BUSY (RTS) protocol: • After the power is turned on, it is always at “High” level.

Printer →

6 DTR • Output signal to the host. For the READY/BUSY (DTR) protocol or XON/XOFF (DC1/DC3) protocol + READY/BUSY (DTR) protocol: • It indicates the ready state for the received data. • It is at “Low” level when the receive buffer is near full,

and at “High” level when near empty. For the XON/XOFF (DC1/DC3) protocol or READY/BUSY (RTS) protocol: • After the power is turned on, it is always at “High”.

Printer →

7 SG • Ground line for all data and control signals. 20 DSR • Input signal from the host.

• For the printer to receive data, it must be at “High” level. ← Host

Printer Host

FG

TD

RD

RTS

CTS

DSR

SG

DTR

Page 10: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 6 -

RD CTS DSR

SN75189 or equivalent

SN75188 or equivalent

TD RTS DTR

(16) Interface Circuit

� Input Circuit

� Output Circuit

� Signal Levels

Input Voltage H...... +3 ~ +15 V L ...... -3 ~ -15 V

Output Voltage H...... +6 ~ +13 V L ...... -6 ~ -13 V

Page 11: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 7 -

3.2 PARALLEL INTERFACE

(1) Type: Centronics

(2) Mode: Conforms to IEEE1284 Compatibility mode and Nibble mode

(3) Data Input Method: Parallel 8 bits (DATA1 ~ 8)

(4) Control Signals: Compatibility mode Nibble mode nStrobe HostClk nAck PrtClk Busy PtrBusy PError AckDataReq Select Xflag nAutoFd HostBusy nInit nInit nFault nDataAvail nSelectIn IEEE1284Active

(5) Data Input Code: ASCII code European character set 8 bit code Graphics 8 bit code

(6) Receive Buffer: 1 MB * The use of the receive buffer is shared between interfaces.

Page 12: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 8 -

(7) Input/Output Circuit Configuration and Input/Output Conditions:

Signal Configuration

DATA1 ~ 8

Logic level

Input

nStrobe/HostClk/HostClk nInit/nInit/

nReverseRequest nAutoFd/HostBusy/

HostAck nSelectIn/IEEE1284Active/

IEEE1284Active

(Input) “1” = 2 ~ 5 V “0” = 0 ~ 0.4 V

Output

Busy/PtrBusy/PeriphAck nFault/nDataAvail/

nPeriphRequest nAck/PtrClk/PeriphClk Select/Xflag/XFlag PError/AckDataReq/

nAckReverse

Logic level (Input) “1” = 2.4 ~ 5 V “0” = 0 ~ 0.4 V

(8) Connector: Printer Amp. Japan 552742-1 or equivalent DDK 57RE-40360-73B or equivalent

Cable Amp. Japan 552470-1 or equivalent DDK 57E-30360 or equivalent

1K SN74LS245 or equivalent

+5V

100P

+5V

1K SN74LS14 or equivalent

+5V

1K

100P

SN7406 or equivalent

Page 13: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 9 -

(9) Connector Pin Diagram (IEEE1284-B Connector):

Pin Signal Name

No. Compatibility Mode Nibble mode

1 nStrobe HostClk

2 Data 1 Data 1

3 Data 2 Data 2

4 Data 3 Data 3

5 Data 4 Data 4

6 Data 5 Data 5

7 Data 6 Data 6

8 Data 7 Data 7

9 Data 8 Data 8

10 nAck PtrClk

11 Busy PtrBusy

12 PError AckDataReq

13 Select Xflag

14 nAutoFd HostBusy

15 NC NC

16 0V 0V

17 CHASSIS GND CHASSIS GND

18 +5V (for detection) +5V (for detection)

19 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN1) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN1)

20 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN2) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN2)

21 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN3) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN3)

22 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN4) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN4)

23 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN5) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN5)

24 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN6) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN6)

25 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN7) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN7)

26 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN8) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN8)

27 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN9) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN9)

28 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN10) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN10)

29 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN11) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN11)

30 TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN31) TWISTED PAIR GND (PIN31)

31 nInit nInit

32 nFault nDataAvail

33 0V 0V

34 NC NC

35 NC NC

36 nSelectIn IEEE1284Active

18 1

36 19

Page 14: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 10 -

(10) Input/Output Signals :

Compatibility mode

� Data 1 ~ 8 (Printer ← Host)

� Input data signals for the 1st to 8th bits.

� Logic 1 is “High” level.

� Min. data pulse width of 2.5 µsec.

� nStrobe (Printer ← Host)

� Synchronizing signal for reading the above data.

� Normally at “High” level. The data is read at the rise of the Low level pulse.

� Minimum data pulse width of 0.5 µsec.

� Busy (Printer → Host)

� This signal indicates that the printer is in a Busy state.

� When initialized after the power is turned on, the printer becomes ready to receive data and turns the signal to “Low” level.

� The signal turns to “High” level (in a Busy state) when data is set from the host (at the fall of the nStrobe signal).

� The signal turns to “Low” level when the printer reads the data.

� When the free space of the receive buffer becomes 512 bytes or less, the printer keeps the signal at “High” level (in a Busy state) for 10 seconds when data is set from the host, to extend the data read interval.

� When the receive buffer has become full, the printer stops reading data. When data is set from the host, then, it keeps the signal at “High” level (in a Busy state) until the receive buffer has a free space.

� The signal is kept at “High” level (in a Busy state) until one of the following states is cleared.

• PAUSE state caused by the [PAUSE] key • Paper end state • Ribbon end state • Head open state • Printer error state • Initialization in progress upon receipt of the nInit signal

� nAck (Printer → Host)

� This signal indicates that the printer has read the data set by the host and is ready to receive the next data.

� The signal is normally at “High”. It is at “Low” for about 5 µsec. after the fall of the BUSY signal. The host should usually set data after the ACK signal is turned from “Low” to “High”.

� If the nAck signal is ignored and the next data is set while the nAck signal is Low, the “LOW” level continues about further 5 µsec at the fall of the BUSY signal. However, the data can be received properly.

Page 15: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 11 -

� nInit (Printer ← Host)

� Reset request signal from the host.

� Normally at “High” level. An input of this signal at “Low” level causes the printer to be initialized in the same manner as when the power is turned on.

* When “Reset process when the nInit signal is ON” is set to “OFF” in the parameter setting in the system mode, the printer is not initialized even if it receives this signal at low level.

� When the nInit signal is input during printing, the printer completes printing one tag/label which is being printed, cancels the next processing, then is initialized in the same manner as when the power is turned on.

* When “Reset process when the nInit signal is ON” is set to “OFF” in the parameter setting in the system mode, the next process proceeds without being canceled.

� Minimum pulse width of 0.5 µsec.

� Select (Printer → Host)

� This is an output signal which indicates whether the printer is in Pause state or placed online. The printer can receive data while placed online.

� The signal is at “Low” level while the printer is in a Pause state.

� The signal is kept at “Low” level (in a Pause state) until one of the following states is cleared.

• Pause state caused by the [PAUSE] key • Paper end state • Ribbon end state • Head open state • Printer error state • Initialization in progress upon power on or receipt of the nInit signal

� nFault (Printer → Host)

� Output signal indicating that the printer is in a Fault state.

� At “Low” level while the printer is in a Fault state.

� The signal is kept at “Low” level (in a Fault state) until one of the following states is cleared.

• Pause state caused by the [PAUSE] key • Paper end state • Ribbon end state • Head open state • Printer error state • Initialization in progress upon power on or receipt of the nInit signal

PError (Printer → Host)

� Output signal indicating a label end or ribbon end state.

� At “High” level when the printer is in a label end or ribbon end state.

� Turns to “Low” level when the label end or ribbon end state is cleared.

+5 V

� This is not a signal but a +5 V power supply voltage.

� The maximum current of 500 mA can be taken out.

� nSelectIn (Printer ← Host)

� Not used

11 nAutoFd (Printer ← Host)

� Not used

Page 16: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 12 -

Nibble mode

� PtrClk (Printer → Host)

� Reverse data transfer phase: It is used for evaluating data sent to the host.

� Reverse idle phase: When the printer changes the signal from Low to High, an interrupt informing the host that the data is available, occurs

� PtrBusy (Printer → Host)

� Reverse data transfer phase: Data bit 3 is used for the first transfer. Data bit 7 is used for the second transfer. Indicates the forward channel is in a Busy state.

� AckDataReq (Printer → Host)

� Reverse data transfer phase: Data bit 2 is used for the first transfer. Data bit 6 is used for the second transfer.

� Reverse idle phase: This signal is set to high until the data transfer is requested by the host. Then, the process is performed according to the nDataAvail signal.

� Xflag (Printer ← Host)

� Reverse data transfer phase: Data bit 1 is used for the first transfer. Data bit 5 is used for the second transfer.

� HostBusy (Printer ← Host)

� Reverse data transfer phase: It indicates that the host can receive data from the printer by setting the signal to low. Then, the host sets the signal to high, and sends the Ack indicating that the nibble data is received. When the signal is set to low after one reverse channel data transfer is performed, the interface phase changes to the idle phase. At that time, there is no available data on the printer.

� Reverse idle phase: When this signal is set to high according to the low pulse of the PtrClk signal, the host enters the reverse data transfer phase again. If this signal is set to high when the IEEE1284 Active signal is low, the IEEE1284 idle phase stops, and the interface enters the Compatibility mode.

� nDataAvail (Printer → Host)

� Reverse data transfer phase: When the signal is low, it indicates the printer has data to be sent to the host. And it is used for sending data bits 0 and 4.

� Reverse idle phase: It is used for indicating that the data is available.

Page 17: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 13 -

(11) Timing Chart

� When receiving normal data:

For the Compatibility mode, one of two types of timing for BUSY-ACK can be selected.

a) Timing 1 (Default)

� When the USB board has not been installed:

b) Timing 2

Data 1 ~ 8 (Host → Printer)

nStrobe (Host → Printer)

Busy (Host ← Printer)

nAck (Host ← Printer)

Approx. 5 µsec

Min. 1 µsec

Min. 1 µsec

Min. 0.5 µsec

Data 1 ~ 8 (Host → Printer)

nStrobe (Host → Printer)

Busy (Host ← Printer)

nAck (Host ← Printer)

Min. 1 µsec

Min. 1 µsec

Min. 0.5 µsec

Approx. 1 µsec

Page 18: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 14 -

� Receiving data in the Compatibility mode when the free space of the receive buffer is 512 bytes or less:

� When the free space of the receive buffer become s 512 bytes or less, the printer stores all data already received in the receive buffer, continues to be in a Busy state (Busy signal at “High” level) for 10 seconds to extend the data read interval when data is set from the host, then reads the data 10 seconds later.

� If the free space becomes 513 bytes or more while waiting for reading data, the printer will receive the data with the normal data receive timing.

� When there is no free space in the receive buffer, the printer stops reading data. When data is set from the host, then the printer continues to be in a Busy state (Busy signal at “High” level) until the receive buffer has a free space.

(12) Relationship between Printer Setting and PC Setting and Their Operation Modes

Host setting Windows95/98/Me WindowsNT4.0 Windows2000/XP

Printer setting Compatibility ECP Compatibility ECP Compatibility ECP

Compatibility mode (SPP) SPP SPP SPP SPP SPP SPP

* SPP mode operations include support for the Nibble mode.

* The printer returns the following 13 byte-status to the Nibble mode negotiation immediately after the [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL] is received. The printer returns 23 bytes (described in (13) Status with the receive buffer free space information on the next page) to the Nibble mode negotiation immediately after the [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] is received.

Status to be returned immediately after the [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL] is received (13 bytes):

SOX STX Status Remaining count ETX EOT CR LF

01H 02H 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 03H 04H 0DH 0AH

511 byte-space

Data 1 ~ 8 (Host → Printer)

nStrobe (Host → Printer)

Busy (Host ← Printer)

nAck (Host ← Printer)

10 sec 10 sec

512 byte-space

0 byte-space

1 byte-space

1 byte -space

Page 19: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 15 -

(13) Status with the receive buffer free space information

The printer should return a status with the receive buffer free space information to the Nibble mode negotiation immediately after [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] is received, as described below.

Status to be returned immediately after [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] is sent (23 bytes):

SOH 01H Indicates the header of the status block

STX 02H

Status 3XH Printer status

3XH * Details are described later.

Status type 33H Indicates that the status includes the receive buffer free space information.

Remaining 3XH Remaining number of labels to be printed

count 3XH * Details are described later.

3XH

3XH

Length 3XH Total number of bytes of this status block.

3XH

Free space 3XH Free space of the receive buffer

of receive buffer 3XH “00000” (0K byte) to “99999” (99999K bytes)

3XH However, the maximum value should be the receive buffer

3XH capacity.

3XH

Receive buffer 3XH Receive buffer capacity

capacity 3XH “00000” (0K byte) to “99999” (99999K bytes)

3XH However, the maximum value differs depending on the models.

3XH

3XH

CR 0DH Indicates the footer of the status block.

LF 0AH

Page 20: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 16 -

3.3 USB INTERFACE

(1) Standard: Conforming to USB Standard Rev. 1.1

(2) Data Transfer Type: Control transfer, Bulk transfer

(3) Transfer Rate: Full speed (12 Mbps)

(4) Transfer Control Method: Status with the receive buffer free space information is sent in response to a read request immediately after [ESC] [WB] [LF][NUL], as described in Section 3.2 PARALLEL INTERFACE, (13).

3.4 NETWORK INTERFACE

(1) Configuration

� 100BASE LAN � Wireless LAN module

(2) Protocol: TCP/IP

(3) Network Specifications

� LPR server function � WEB printer function � Socket communication function � E-mail transmission/reception function

* For more details on the network, refer to the Network Specification (EAA-2167).

Page 21: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 17 -

4. KEY OPERATION FUNCTIONS

4.1 SYSTEM MODE FUNCTIONS

The system mode has the following functions for the printer self -test and setting various parameters. For details, refer to Key Operation Specification (EAA-2166).

(1) Self-test

• Maintenance counter/various parameters printouts • Automatic self-test • Head broken dots check

(2) Various parameters settings

• Character code selection • Selection of font 0 • RS-232C communication speed • RS-232C data length • RS-232C stop bit length • RS-232C parity • RS-232C transmission control • Language for LCD messages • Forward feed standby • Control code • Peel-off wait status selection • [FEED] key function • Kanji code selection • Euro code setting • Automatic head broken dots check • Centronics ACK/BUSY timing setting • Web printer function setting • Reset process when the nInit signal is ON • Ribbon near end detection setting • Plug-and-play operation mode • Label end/ribbon end process setting • Pre-strip function setting • Reverse feed speed setting • MaxiCode specification setting

(3) Various parameters settings

• Feed amount fine adjustment • Cut (strip) position fine adjustment • Reverse feed amount fine adjustment • X-coordinate fine adjustment • Print density fine adjustment (Thermal transfer print mode) • Print density fine adjustment (Direct thermal print mode) • Ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment (Take-up side) • Ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment (Feed side) • Reflective sensor manual threshold fine adjustment • Transmissive sensor manual threshold fine adjustment

Page 22: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 18 -

(4) Test print

• Print conditions setting • 1-dot slant line printout • 3-dot slant line printout • Character printout • Bar code printout • Non-printing • Line printout for the assembly process check • Automatic printout for the assembly process check (Transmissive sensor) • Automatic printout for the assembly process check (Reflective sensor)

(5) Sensor display/adjustment

• Thermal head temperature sensor display • Ambient temperature sensor display • Reflective sensor state display/adjustment • Transmissive sensor state display/adjustment • Reflective sensor adjustment value setting (without paper) • Transmissive sensor adjustment value setting (without paper)

(6) RAM clear

• Maintenance counter clear • Parameter clear

(7) IP address setting

• Printer IP address • Gateway IP address • Subnet mask • Socket communication port • DHCP setting • DHCP client ID setting

(8) BASIC setting

• BASIC setting • BASIC file browser • BASIC trace setting • Extend BASIC mode

(9) Assembly process check

• Option check

(10) RFID Setting

• RFID module type selection • RFID error tag detection • Max. number of RFID issue retries • Max. number of RFID read retries • RFID read retry time-out • Max. number of RFID write retries • RFID write retry time-out • RFID adjustment for retry

Page 23: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 19 -

(11) Initial values after RAM clear

• Initial values after maintenance counter clear

Parameter Initial Value

Label distance covered 0 km Printed distance 0 km Cut count 0 Ribbon motor drive time 0 hour RS-232C hardware error count 0 System error count 0 Momentary power interruption count 0

• Initial values after parameter clear

Parameter Initial Value

Feed amount fine adjustment (PC) 0 mm Cut position (or strip position) fine adjustment (PC)

0 mm

Reverse feed amount fine adjustment (PC) 0 mm Print density fine adjustment (Thermal transfer print mode) (PC)

0

Print density fine adjustment (Direct thermal print mode) (PC)

0

Ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment (Take-up side) (PC)

0

Ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment (Feed side) (PC)

0

Feed amount fine adjustment (Key) 0 mm Cut position (or strip position) fine adjustment (Key)

0 mm

Reverse feed amount fine adjustment (Key) 0 mm Print density fine adjustment (Thermal transfer print mode) (Key)

0

Print density fine adjustment (Direct thermal print mode) (Key)

0

Ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment (Take-up side) (Key)

0

Ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment (Feed side) (Key)

0

X-coordinate fine adjustment (Key) 0 mm Transmissive sensor manual threshold fine adjustment value

1.4 V

Reflective sensor manual threshold fine adjustment value

1.0 V

Type of character code PC-850 Font of 0 “0” (without slash mark) Communication speed 9600 bps Data length 8 bits Stop bit length 1 bit Parity NONE

Page 24: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Parameter Initial Value Flow control XON/XOFF + READY/BUSY (DTR)

protocol: (XON output when the power is on, XOFF output when the power is off)

Language for LCD messages English Forward feed standby after an issue OFF Type of control code Auto Strip wait status selection OFF [FEED] key function FEED (One label is fed.) Kanji code TYPE1 Euro code B0H Automatic head broken dots check OFF Centronics ACK/BUSY timing setting TYPE 1 Web printer function OFF Reset process when the nInit signal is ON ON Ribbon near end detection setting OFF Expansion I/O operation mode TYPE1 Plug-and-play operation mode OFF Label end/ribbon end process setting Printing is stopped when a label end

or ribbon end is detected. Pre strip process setting OFF Reverse feed speed 3”/sec MaxiCode specification setting Compatible with existing version Status response ON Label pitch 76.2 mm Effective print length 74.2 mm Effective print width 203 dpi 104.0 mm 300 dpi 105.7 mm Print method Thermal transfer Type of sensor Transmissive sensor Feed speed 4”/sec Issue mode Batch PC save automatic call ON BASIC interpreter setting OFF BASIC interpreter trace setting OFF DHCP setting OFF RFID module type selection None RFID error tag detection None Max. number of RFID issue retries 3 Max. number of RFID read retries 5 RFID read retry time-out 4.0 sec. Max. number of RFID write retries 5 RFID write retry time-out 2.0 sec. RFID adjustment for retry Invalid: 0 mm

• The total label distance covered, sensor adjustment values (system mode <5>), IP address setting, socket communication number setting, and data of the flash memory are not cleared by RAM clear.

- 20 -

Page 25: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

4.2 ONLINE MODE FUNCTIONS

The online mode has the following functions for issuing labels and setting the threshold. (For details, refer to Key Operation Specification (EAA-2166).)

(1) Issuing labels (by external equipment interface commands)

(2) Paper feed (by the [FEED] key)

(3) Pause (Halts issuing labels by the [PAUSE] key)

(4) Restart (Reissues labels by the [RESTART] key after halting issuing labels or after the occurrence of an error.)

(5) Reset (Enters a usual initial state which is obtained after the power is turned on, using the [RESTART] key.)

(6) Error indication

(7) Threshold setting

(8) Various parameters settings

(9) Various fine adjustments setting

(10) Dumping of receive buffer

(11) BASIC expansion mode

(12) Auto calibration setting

(13) LAN enable/disable setting

4.3 DOWNLOAD MODE SETTING FUNCTION

When the power is turned on while holding down the [FEED], [PAUSE], and [RESTART] keys at the same time, the printer enters the download mode. Therefore, the usual operations cannot be performed. For details, refer to the Key Operation Specification (EAA-2166).

- 21 -

Page 26: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 22 -

5. TRANSMISSION SEQUENCE

This section describes the outline of the transmission sequence.

5.1 INITIAL SETTING

Writable characters, logos, and PC interface commands must be stored before the label issue operation.

(1) Storing writable characters and logos

NOTES: (1) Store writable characters or logos only when it is required to do so.

(2) When the flash memory is used, the memory will be taken up with every such storing if the Format Command is not sent before storing already stored writable characters or logos.

(3) When the flash memory is used, and another operation (storing PC interface commands or label issue operation) is performed after storing writable characters or logos, the image buffer will be cleared automatically.

(4) If further storing operation does not take place after storing writable characters or logos, the printer automatically enters the online mode (label issue operation) in about 10 seconds. In this case, when the flash memory is used, the image buffer will be cleared automatically.

Power ON

<New>

Format Command

Bit Map Writable Character Command

Yes (Add/change)

[ESC] J1: Formats the flash memory.

Completion of storing all characters

• Storing PC interface commands • Label issue operation

No

Yes

[ESC] XD: Stores writable characters or logos on the flash memory.

No

Page 27: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 23 -

(2) Storing PC interface commands

NOTES: (1) Store the PC commands only when it is required to do so. (2) When the flash memory is used, the memory will be taken up with every such storing if

the Format Command is not sent before storing already stored PC interface commands. (3) When the flash memory is used, and another operation (storing writable characters or

logos, label issue operation) is performed after storing PC interface commands, the image buffer will be cleared automatically.

(4) Select commands to be stored as the occasion demands. (5) If further storing operation does not take place after storing PC interface commands, the

printer enters the online mode (label issue operation) in about 10 seconds. In this case, the image buffer will be cleared automatically.

Power ON

<New>

Format Command

Bit Map Font Data Command

No

Yes (Add/change) [ESC] J1: Formats the flash memory.

Completion of storing all commands

• Storing writable characters or logos • Label issue operation

No

Yes

[ESC] XO: Declares the start of saving PC interface commands.

Save Start Command

Label Size Set Command

Position Fine Adjust Command

Print Density Fine Adjust Command

Image Buffer Clear Command

Line Format Command

Bit Map Font Format Command

Outline Font Format Command

Bar Code Format Command

Save Terminate Command

[ESC] D: Sets the label size.

[ESC] AX: Adjusts the feed amount, cut position, and back feed amount.

[ESC] AY: Adjusts the print density.

[ESC] C: Clears the image buffer.

[ESC] LC: Sets the line format and draws it.

[ESC] PC: Sets the bit map font format.

[ESC] PV: Sets the outline font format.

[ESC] XB: Sets the bar code format.

[ESC] RC: Draws data of the bit map font.

[ESC] XP: Declares the termination of saving PC interface commands.

Page 28: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 24 -

5.2 LABEL ISSUE OPERATION

An example of the label issue operation is described below.

(1) When the Saved Data Call Command is not used:

NOTES: (1) When loading new type paper, the Label Size Set Command and the Feed Command must always be sent. When using the same paper after the power is turned off and on, the Label Size Set Command and the Feed Command may be omitted.

(2) After the power is turned off and on, the Bit Map Font Format Command, the Outline Font Format Command, and the Bar Code Format Command should be sent as occasion demands because they are not stored in memory.

Power ON

Bit Map Font Data Command

<Data change> Yes

Position Fine Adjust Command

Print Density Fine Adjust Command

Image Buffer Clear Command

Line Format Command

Bit Map Font Format Command

Outline Font Format Command

Bar Code Format Command

[ESC] D: Sets the label size.

[ESC] AX: Adjusts the feed amount, cut position, and back feed amount.

[ESC] AY: Adjusts the print density.

[ESC] C: Clears the image buffer.

[ESC] LC: Sets the line format and draws it.

[ESC] PC: Sets the bit map font format.

[ESC] PV: Sets the outline font format.

[ESC] XB: Sets the bar code format.

[ESC] RC: Draws bit map font data.

Feed Command [ESC] T: Feeds one label to align with the print start

position.

Outline Font Data Command [ESC] RV: Draws outline font data.

Bar Code Data Command [ESC] RB: Draws bar code data.

Issue Command [ESC] XS: Issues (prints) the label.

No <Format change>

Yes

No <Label change>

Yes

No

Power OFF

Label Size Set Command

Set the labels.

Page 29: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 25 -

(2) When the Saved Data Call Command is used:

NOTES: (1) When loading new type paper, the Feed Command must always be sent. When using the same paper after the power is turned off and on, the Feed Command may be omitted.

(2) If the option for “automatic call at power on” for the Saved Data Call Command has previously been selected, the Saved Data Call Command may be omitted after the power is turned off and on.

(3) When the XML data is used:

Print data in XML format can be sent to the printer.

* For details, refer to the XML Data Print Specification (TAA-1320).

Power ON

Bit Map Font Data Command

<Data change> Yes

Set the labels.

Saved Data Call Command

[ESC] XQ: Calls the label format stored in the flash memory.

[ESC] RC: Draws bit map font data.

Feed Command [ESC] T: Feeds one label to align with the print start position.

Outline Font Data Command [ESC] RV: Draws outline font data.

Bar Code Data Command [ESC] RB: Draws bar code data.

Issue Command [ESC] XS: Issues (prints) the label.

No <Label change> Yes

No

Power OFF

Page 30: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 26 -

6. INTERFACE COMMANDS

6.1 OUTLINE OF COMMANDS

(1) Format of Interface command

� The length from [ESC] to [LF] [NUL] must be as specified by each command.

� There are the following three kinds of control codes: � ESC (1BH), LF (0AH), NUL (00H)

� { (7BH), | (7CH), } (7DH) � Code set in the system mode

(2) How to use reference

Function Describes the outline of the function of the command.

Format Shows the format of the command.

The format designation method should conform to the following rules:

• Each set of small letters (such as aa, bbbb) indicates a parameter item. • An item enclosed in parentheses may be omitted. • “…” indicates the repetition of an item. • Brackets and parentheses are used only in coding, and must not be transmitted

in practice. • Other symbols must always be inserted at designated positions when

transmitted.

Term Explains the term(s) used in the format.

* “0 to 999” described in the entry range indicates that up to 3-digit variable-length entry is allowed. (Entry of “001” or “009” is also possible.) “000 to 999” indicates that the entry must be fixed as 3 digits.

Explanation Explains the command in detail.

Note Supplementary explanation of the command.

Refer to Related commands

Examples Explains the command examples.

The above corresponds to the transfer of the following:

(3) Precautions

ESC Command & Data LF NUL

[ESC] T20C30 [LF] [NUL]

1B 54 30 30 43 33 32 0A 00 [ESC] T 2 0 C 3 0 [LF] [NUL]

The commands and parameters described in this specification must always be used. If any command or parameter other than those covered in this specification are used, the printer’s operation will not be guaranteed. The commands must be used in the online mode. If any command is transmitted in the system mode, the printer will not operate. However, only the Reset Command can be used.

Page 31: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.2 LIST OF COMMANDS

(1) Commands related to setting

Label Size Set Command [ESC] D......................................29

(2) Commands related to fine adjustment

Position Fine Adjust Command [ESC] AX....................................33 Print Density Fine Adjust Command [ESC] AY....................................38 Ribbon Motor Drive Voltage Fine Adjust Command [ESC] RM...................................39

(3) Commands related to clear

Image Buffer Clear Command [ESC] C......................................40 Clear Area Command [ESC] XR ...................................41

(4) Commands related to drawing format setting

Line Format Command [ESC] LC....................................43 Bit Map Font Format Command [ESC] PC ...................................56 Outline Font Format Command [ESC] PV....................................61 Bar Code Format Command [ESC] XB....................................77

(5) Commands related to print data

Bit Map Font Data Command [ESC] RC .................................116 Outline Font Data Command [ESC] RV .................................120 Bar Code Data Command [ESC] RB .................................123

(6) Commands related to issue and feed

Issue Command [ESC] XS..................................136 Feed Command [ESC] T ....................................149 Eject Command [ESC] IB ...................................155 Forward/Reverse Feed Command [ESC] U1, [ESC] U2.................156

(7) Commands related to writable characters

Storage Area Allocate Command [ESC] XF..................................158 Flash Memory Format Command [ESC] J1...................................160 2-byte Writable Character Code Range Command [ESC] XE..................................161 Bit Map Writable Character Command (for flash memory) [ESC] XD .................................162 (8) Commands related to graphics

Graphic Command [ESC] SG .................................171

(9) Commands related to PC command saving

Flash Memory Format Command [ESC] J1...................................160 Save Start Command (for flash memory) [ESC] XO .................................179 Save Terminate Command [ESC] XP..................................180 Saved Data Call Command (for flash memory) [ESC] XQ .................................181

- 27 -

Page 32: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(10) Commands related to check

Head Broken Dots Check Command [ESC] HD .................................182

(11) Commands related to display

Message Display Command [ESC] XJ ..................................183

(12) Commands related to control

Reset Command [ESC] WR ................................185 Batch Reset Command [ESC] Z0 ..................................202

(13) Commands related to status

Status Request Command [ESC] WS.................................186 Receive Buffer Free Space Request Command [ESC] WB.................................187 Version Information Acquire Command [ESC] WV.................................188 Printer Option Status Acquire Command [ESC] WN ................................189

(14) Commands related to TCP/IP setting

IP Address Set Command [ESC] IP ...................................190 Socket Communication Port Set Command [ESC] IS ...................................191 DHCP Function Set Command [ESC] IH...................................192

(15) Commands related to internal serial interface

Pass-through Command [ESC] @002.............................193 Internal Serial Interface Parameter Set Command [ESC] IZ ...................................194

(16) Commands related to parameter setting

Parameter Set Command [ESC] Z2;1 ...............................195 Fine Adjustment Value Set Command [ESC] Z2;2 ...............................199 RFID Parameter Set Command [ESC] Z2;3 ...............................201

(17) Commands related to RFID

RFID Tag Position Adjustment Command [ESC] @003.............................203 RFID Tag Read Command [ESC] WF.................................204 RFID Void Pattern Print Command [ESC] @006.............................206

- 28 -

Page 33: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3 COMMANDS FOR CREATING APPLICATION

6.3.1 LABEL SIZE SET COMMAND [ESC] D

Function Sets the size of a label or tag paper.

Format [ESC] Daaaa, bbbb, cccc (, dddd) [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: Pitch length of the label or tag 4 and 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units) 4 digits: 0100 (10.0 mm) to 9999 (999.9 mm) 5 digits: 00100 (10.0 mm) to 09990 (999.0 mm)

bbbb: Effective print width Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units) 0100 (10.0 mm) to 1057 (105.7 mm)

cccc: Effective print length 4 and 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units) 4 digits: 0060 (6.0 mm) to 9970 (997.0 mm) 5 digits: 00060 (6.0 mm) to 09970 (997.0 mm)

dddd: Backing paper width (Omissible. When omitted, the initial value is used as the effective print width.) Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units) 0300 (30.0 mm) to 1120 (112.0 mm)

Explanation

0X

Y

Label

Paper feed direction

Label pitch

Backing paper

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

[Printing direction: Top first]

[Labels]

Label

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y

Label pitch

Backing paper width

Backing paper

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

[Printing direction: Bottom first]

Backing paper width

- 29 -

Page 34: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

[Tag paper]

Tag

Paper feed direction

0 X

[Setting range]

[Labels] [Tags]

Black mark (Back side of the paper)

Paper feed direction

B

E

A

G D C

H

Origin

Origin

I

Cut position

Stop position

IStop position

H

G C

F

A

Tag

Origin

Origin

Cut position

Y

Tag pitch

Black mark (Back side of the paper)

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

[Printing direction: Bottom first]

Tag

Paper feed direction

Tag pitchEffective

print length

Effective print width

Black mark (Back side of the paper)

0X

Y

[Printing direction: Top first]

- 30 -

Page 35: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[mm]

Model 203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Thermal head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Thermal head width 104.0 mm 105.7 mm

Range of values which can be set on the software Min 10.0 25.4 19.0 10.0 25.4 19.0

Label Max. 999.0 999.0 Min. 10.0 --- 19.0 10.0 --- 19.0

A: Label pitch Tag pitch

Tag Max. 999.0 – 999.0 999.0 – 999.0 Min. 8.0 23.4 13.0 80. 23.4 13.0 B: Label length Max. 997.0 993.0 997.0 993.0 Min. 25.0 50.0 25.0 25.0 50.0 25.0 C: Backing paper width

Tag width Max. 118.0 118.0 Min. 23.0 47.0 23.0 23.0 47.0 23.0 D: Label width Max. 118.0 118.0 Min. 2.0 6.0 2.0 6.0 E: Label-to-label gap Max. 20.0 20.0 Min. 2.0 2.0 F: Black mark length Max. 10.0 10.0 Min. 10.0 10.0 G: Effective print width Max. 104.0 105.7 Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0

Label Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 – 11.0 8.0 – 11.0

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 – 997.0 997.0 – 997.0

Slow-up 1.0 1.0 I: Slow up/ down interval Slow-down 1.0 1.0

Label 130μm to 170μm J: Thickness Tag 130μm to 170μm

K: Max. effective print length for on-the-fly issuing

499.0 499.0

When a cut issue is performed, label length B should be as follows:

Label length B ≥ 22.0 mm − Label-to-label gap2

Notes (1) Before changing the label size or type of sensor, the Label Size Set Command must first be transmitted.

(2) The Label Size Set Command is stored in memory (retained even if the power is turned off).

(3) After sending the Label Size Set Command, the Feed Command ([ESC] T) must be transmitted prior to printing, to feed one piece of paper so that the print head position aligns with the print start position.

(4) The origin of drawing coordinates, print stop position (print head position when printing stops), and cut position are determined according to the parameters of the Label Size Set Command as shown in the figure on the preceding page. For the print stop position in strip issue mode, refer to the section of the Position Fine Adjust Command. The effective print area is centered on the label/tag.

(5) Printing cannot be performed in the slow up (1 mm) and slow down (1 mm) areas. Consequently, [A : Label pitch/Tag pitch] − [H: Effective print length] ≥ 2 mm must be assumed.

- 31 -

Page 36: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(6) The origin of drawing coordinates, print stop position (print head position when printing stops), and cut position are adjustable by the Fine Adjust Commands and according to the fine adjustment settings in the system mode.

(7) The tag rotation designation of the Issue Command ([ESC] XS) causes the origin of drawing coordinates to be origin in the case of “bottom first” and to be origin

in the case of “top first”, as shown in the figure.

(8) The parameters must be as shown in the figure and table. Any value or paper outside the range results in a failure of printing or an error.

(9) Where an effective print length is specified within the range of “max. effective print length for on-the-fly”, non-stop printing is possible even if the data to be printed is different one by one because printing and drawing of the next label are processed at the same time. [On-the-fly issue]

However, printing may stop every label depending on the volume of drawing data.

. Examples (1) Labels (2) Tags

Effective print area

[ESC] D0508, 0760, 0468, 0820 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] D0762, 0996, 0722 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T20C40 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T10C40 [LF] [NUL]

46.8 mm

50.8 mm

76.0 mm

Label

Backing paper

72.2mm

76.2mm

99.6 mm

Effective print area

Tag

Black mark (Back side of the paper)

82.0 mm

- 32 -

Page 37: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.2 POSITION FINE ADJUST COMMAND [ESC] AX

Function Adjusts the feed amount so that the label stops at the position in front of or behind the automatically set print start position.

Adjusts the cut position so that the label is cut at a position in front of or behind the automatically set cut position, or adjusts the strip position so that the label stops at the position in front of or behind the automatically set strip position.

Adjusts the reverse feed amount to the home position after a cut, or adjusts the reverse feed amount to the home position after a strip operation.

Format [ESC] AX; abbb, cddd, eff [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Indicates the direction of the print start position fine adjustment +: Front −: Behind

bbb: Fine adjustment value 000 to 500 (in 0.1 mm units)

c: Indicates the direction of the cut position (or strip position) fine adjustment +: Front −: Behind

ddd: Fine adjustment value 000 to 500 (in 0.1 mm units)

e: Indicates whether the reverse feed amount is to be increased or decreased. +: Increase −: Decrease

ff: Reverse feed amount fine adjustment value 00 to 99 (in 0.1 mm units)

- 33 -

Page 38: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Explanation [Print Start Position Fine Adjustment] (To finely adjust the print start position so that it shifts backward or forward)

0.0 mm

+3.0 mm

−3.0 mm

Print start position

Paper feed direction

One label

One label

One label

Print start position

Print start position

[Cut Position Fine Adjustment] (To finely adjust the cut position backward or forward)

0.0 mm

Cut position

+3.0 mm

Cut position

− 3.0 mm

Cut position Paper feed direction

- 34 -

Page 39: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Strip Position Fine Adjustment]

0.0 mm

+3.0 mm

−3.0 mm

• In strip issue mode, a label is stopped at the position where the distance between the middle point of the label-to-label gap and the edge of the strip shaft is 4 mm, since the label-to-label gap is assumed to be 2 mm.

• When the print start position is not proper, it should be adjusted using the strip position fine adjustment function.

• When the label-to-label gap is 5 mm or more, the effective print length should be set to the maximum (label pitch -2 mm). Then, the print start position should be adjusted using the strip position fine adjust function.

2 mm

3 mm 4 mm

[Reverse Feed Amount Fine Adjustment] (To finely adjust the reverse feed amount so that the print start position shifts backward or

forward)

0.0 mm

+3.0 mm

Print start position (home position after reverse feed)

Print start position (home position after reverse feed)

Print start position (home position after reverse feed)

- 3.0 mm

Paper feed direction

- 35 -

Page 40: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes (1) If the print start position fine adjustment (feed amount fine adjustment), cut position (or strip position) fine adjustment or reverse feed amount fine adjustment has been set in the system mode (by key operation on the printer), the fine adjustment value will be the sum of the value set by this command and that in the system mode. Each maximum fine adjustment value is as follows. However, the maximum print start position fine adjustment (feed amount fine adjustment) value must be within the label pitch.

Print start position fine adjustment..............................................±50.0 mm Cut position (or strip position) fine adjustment............................±50.0 mm Reverse feed amount fine adjustment ........................................±9.9 mm

(2) After changing the fine adjustment value by this command, one label must be fed by the Feed Command ([ESC] T) to adjust the print start position.

(3) Each fine adjustment value is stored in memory (retained even if the power is turned off).

(4) If a fine adjustment value is improper, printing will not be performed correctly.

For example, if the reverse feed amount fine adjustment value is not properly set, the print position differs between the labels to be cut and those not to be cut. If the label is excessively fed backward, it will not be fed correctly during printing.

In the strip issue mode, the print start position may differ between the first label and the second label. The reverse feed amount fine adjustment for the strip issue is used to adjust the feed amount so that a label is stopped at the correct position where the automatic forward feed is ready to be performed.

(5) The cut position (or the strip position) fine adjustment and the reverse feed amount fine adjustment are effective only when the printer is in cut issue or strip issue mode.

(6) How the labels with the label pitch of 19 mm or less are handled in the cut issue mode:

The minimum label pitch for the normal cut issue is 19 mm. When a label with the label pitch of less than 19 mm is used (though it is out of specifications), the edge of the label may be caught on the edge of the thermal head during a reverse feed to the home position, after the gap between labels is cut. Therefore, the label may not be return to the proper home position.

(8) Labels may not returned to the home position depending on the print conditions, even if the same amount of reverse feed is performed. When the media sensor is used and if the label pitch is almost the same size as the distance between the print head and the media sensor (67.9 mm), a label/tag may not be returned to the home position by a reverse feed after a cut issue, a strip issue, or an automatic forward feed standby function. It may result in an error. In such cases, increasing the reverse feed amount (fine adjusting the reverse feed amount in the + direction) can prevent this error.

- 36 -

Page 41: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples (1) Cut issue

[ESC] AX; +020, +035, +10 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T21C40 [LF] [NUL]

Cut

2.0 mm

2.0 mm

3.5 mm

3.0 mm

Cut

Paper feed direction

Pre-print

Fine adjust the print position by +2.0 mm.

Fine adjust the cut position by +3.5 mm.

Finely adjust the reverse feed amount by +1.0 mm. (3.0 - 2.0 = 1.0)

(2) Strip issue

1.0 mm 3.0 mm

A B C

[ESC] AX; +010, +020, +00 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T20D40 [LF] [NUL]

A B C Fine adjust the strip

position by +2.0 mm. Fine adjust the print

position by +1.0 mm. 1.0 mm

Paper feed direction

- 37 -

Page 42: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.3 PRINT DENSITY FINE ADJUST COMMAND [ESC] AY

Function Adjusts the print density which was automatically set.

Format [ESC] AY; abb, c [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Indicates whether to increase or decrease the density. +: Increase (darker) −: Decrease (lighter)

bb: Print density fine adjustment value 00 to 10 (in units of 1 step)

c: Indicates the print mode (thermal transfer or direct thermal) 0: Thermal transfer 1: Direct thermal

Explanation (1) The print density fine adjustment is performed by adjusting the length of time to apply voltage to the thermal head.

(2) If the print density fine adjustment value has been set in system mode (by key operation on the printer), the fine adjustment value will be the sum of the value set by this command and that in the system mode. The maximum fine adjustment value for each of the thermal transfer and direct thermal print modes is ±10.

(3) The fine adjustment values in thermal transfer print mode and direct thermal print mode can be set independently.

(4) The Print Density Fine Adjust Command is stored in memory (retained even if the power is turned off).

(5) The factory default of the fine adjustment value is 00, for both the fine adjust command and the system mode fine adjustment.

(6) The maximum adjustment value differs depending on the print speed. When the value exceeds the maximum, it is automatically corrected to the maximum value.

203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head Print speed Direct thermal Thermal transfer Direct thermal Thermal transfer

2 ips +10 step +10 step +10 step +10 step 4 ips +8 step +10 step +8 step +10 step 6 ips +8 step +10 step +8 step +10 step

Examples To set the print density to “–2” for the thermal transfer mode.

[ESC] AY; -02, 0 [LF] [NUL]

To set the print density to “+3” for the direct thermal mode.

[ESC] AY; +03, 1 [LF] [NUL]

- 38 -

Page 43: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.4 RIBBON MOTOR DRIVE VOLTAGE FINE ADJUST COMMAND [ESC] RM

Function Fine adjusts the drive voltage of the ribbon motor.

Format [ESC] RM; abbcdd [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Direction of the ribbon take-up motor voltage fine adjustment -: Negative (The voltage is lowered.)

bb: Fine adjustment value for the ribbon take-up motor 00 to 15 (in units of 1 step)

c: Direction of the ribbon feed motor voltage fine adjustment -: Negative (The voltage is lowered.)

dd: Fine adjustment value for the ribbon feed motor 00 to 15 (in units of 1 step)

Explanation (1) If the ribbon wrinkles, it can be solved by a find adjustment of the ribbon motor drive voltage by this command.

(2) −1 step corresponds to −5% of the standard drive voltage.

(3) The ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment value is stored in memory (retained even if the power is turned off).

(4) If the ribbon motor drive voltage fine adjustment value has been set in the system mode (by key operation on the printer), the fine adjustment value will be the sum of the value set by this command and that in the system mode. The maximum fine adjustment values are as shown below.

Take-up side Feed side Model Min. Max. Min. Max.

203-dpi print head model -15 +2 -15 +10 300-dpi print head model -15 +2 -15 +10

(5) When a RAM clear is performed, the fine adjustment value for each of the command (take-up/feed) and the system mode will be reset to 00.

(6) The factory default of the fine adjustment values is 00, for both command (take-up/feed) and the system mode.

Example To set the value for the ribbon take-up motor to “−3”, and the value for the ribbon feed motor to “−2”.

[ESC] RM; -03-02 [LF] [NUL]

- 39 -

Page 44: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.5 IMAGE BUFFER CLEAR COMMAND [ESC] C

Function Clears the image buffer for drawing characters, lines, bar codes, and graphics.

Format [ESC] C [LF] [NUL]

Explanation (1) After changing the label size, the image buffer must be cleared.

(2) The increment/decrement designation (described later) is effective until the Image Buffer Clear Command is transmitted.

(3) The link field designation (described later) is effective until the Image Buffer Clear Command is transmitted.

Examples [ESC] D0508, 0760, 0468 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T20C41 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC000; ABC [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; DEF [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0001, 0002C41000 [LF] [NUL]

- 40 -

Page 45: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.6 CLEAR AREA COMMAND [ESC] XR

Function Clears the designated area or reverses the white/black dot pattern in the designated area in the drawing area.

Format [ESC] XR; aaaa, bbbb, cccc, dddd, e [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: X-coordinate of the designated area start point Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

bbbb: Y-coordinate of the designated area start point 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: X-coordinate of the designated area end point Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

dddd: Y-coordinate of the designated area end point 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

e: Type of clear A: Clears the contents in the designated area to zero. B: Reverses the white/black dot pattern in the designated area.

Explanation

[Printing direction: Bottom first] [Printing direction: Top first]

Notes (1) Print result will be the same even if the start and end point coordinates are reversed.

Backing paper

Label

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y

Label

Paper feed direction0X

Y

Backing paper

(2) Print result will be the same even if the start point is set to the upper right and the end point is set to the lower left, respectively.

(3) The start and end point coordinates of the designated area must be set within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D).

Start point

End point

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

Effective print length

Effective print width

End point

Start point

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

- 41 -

Page 46: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Effective print area] [mm]

Model 203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Print head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Print head width 104.0 mm 105.7 mm

Min. 10.0 10.0 G: Effective print width Max. 104.0 105.7 Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0

Label Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 --- 11.0 8.0 --- 11.0

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 --- 997.0 997.0 --- 997.0

Example

10.0 mm

58.5 mm

34.5 mm

76.2 mm

Origin (0, 0) Start point of designated area

Effective print area

Designated area

End point of designated area

[ESC] XR; 0345, 0100, 0762, 0585, A [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC000; ABC [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; DEF [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0001, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 42 -

Page 47: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.7 LINE FORMAT COMMAND [ESC] LC

Function Sets the line format and draws the line.

Format [ESC] LC; aaaa, bbbb, cccc, dddd, e, f (, ggg) [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: X-coordinate of the start point Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

bbbb: Y-coordinate of the start point 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: X-coordinate of the end point Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

dddd: X-coordinate of the end point 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

e: Type of line 0: Line (horizontal, vertical, or slant) 1: Rectangle 2: Line with dots skipped (horizontal line, vertical line) 3: Rectangle with dots skipped

f: No. of line width dots 1 to 9 or 01 to 99 (in 0.1 mm units)

ggg: Radius of rounded corners of a rectangle (Omissible. If omitted, the chamfering process for rectangle corners is not performed.) Fixed as 3 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

Explanation

Backing paper

Label

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y

Backing paper

Effective print length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print width

Start point End point

Paper feed direction

Label

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0) Effective

print width

End point

Start point

Effective print length

X 0

Y

[Printing direction: Bottom first] [Printing direction: Top first]

- 43 -

Page 48: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Line]

(1) Horizontal line (In the case of |Y2 - Y1| = 0)

(X1,Y1) (X2,Y2)

Line width

(2) Vertical line (In the case of |X2 - X1| = 0)

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

Line width

(3) Slant line A ( |X2 - X1| ≤ |Y2 - Y1| ) (4) Slant line B ( |X2 - X1| > |Y2 - Y1| )

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)Line width Line width

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

Line width

Line width

- 44 -

Page 49: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Rectangle]

(1) Radius of rounded corners = 000, or parameter is omitted

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2) (X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

Line width

Line width Line width

Line width

(2) Radius of rounded corners ≠ 000

Radius

(X2,Y2)Line width

Line width (X1,Y1)

- 45 -

Page 50: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Line with some dots skipped]

(1) Horizontal line

(X1,Y1) (X2,Y2)

Line width + 1 dot

Dots are skipped at the top and bottom areas only, which means that the thicker the line width is, the thicker the middle area of the line is.

(2) Vertical line

Line width + 1 dot

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

Dots are skipped at the leftmost and rightmost areas only, which means that the thicker the line width is, the thicker the middle area of the line is.

[Rectangle]

(1) Radius of rounded corners = 000, or parameter is omitted

Line width + 1 dot

(X1,Y1)

(X2,Y2)

Line width + 1 dot

Dots are skipped at the top, bottom, leftmost and rightmost areas only, which means that the thicker the line width is, the thicker the middle area of the line is.

- 46 -

Page 51: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(2) Rounded corners of a rectangle ≠ 000

Radius

Line width + 1 dot(X1,Y1)

Line width + 1 dot (X2,Y2)

Notes (1) In case of line designation, a horizontal line, vertical line, or slant line A/B is drawn

according to the start and end point coordinates.

(2) Print result will be the same even if the start and end point coordinates are reversed.

(3) The start and end point coordinates must be set so that the result of line drawing will be within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D).

(4) Designation of the radius of the rounded corner is effective only when the type of line is set to 1 (rectangle) or 3 (rectangle with dots skipped). When the type of line is set to 0 or 2, designation of the radius is ignored. When the type of line is set to 1 or 3 and the radius of the rounded corner is set to 000 or omitted, a normal rectangle is drawn.

(5) On the following condition, a circle is supposed to be drawn:

| X2 - X1 | 2

| Y2 - Y1 |2 ≤ [Radius of rounded corners] =

[Effective print area] [mm] Model 203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Print head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Print head width 104.0 105.7

Min. 10.0 10.0 G: Effective print width Max. 104.0 105.7

Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0 Label Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 --- 11.0 8.0 --- 11.4

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 --- 997.0 997.0 --- 997.0

- 47 -

Page 52: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Example

5.0 mm

28.0 mm

20.0 mm

30.5 mm

0.4 mm

0.4 mm

Origin (0, 0)

Effective print area

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] LC; 0200, 0350, 0305, 0050, 0, 4 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] LC; 0200, 0050, 0200, 0280, 0, 4 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0001, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 48 -

Page 53: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.8 BIT MAP FONT FORMAT COMMAND [ESC] PC

Function Sets the format indicating where and how the bit map font is to be printed on a label.

Format [ESC] PCaaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff (, ghh), ii, j (, Jkkll) (, Mm) (, noooooooooo) (, Zpp) (, Pq) (=rrr------rrr) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] PCaaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff (, ghh), ii, j (, Jkkll) (, Mm) (, noooooooooo) (, Zpp) (, Pq) (; ss1, ss2, ss3, ------, ss20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aaa: Character string number 000 to 199 (two digits, 00 to 99, also acceptable)

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of character string Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of character string 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Character horizontal magnification 1 to 9 (in magnifications)

* Two-digit designation enables the magnifications in 0.5 units (05 ~ 95: 0.5 to 9.5 magnifications). The magnification can be designated in 0.1 units between 0.5 to 1. (06 ~ 09: 0.6 to 0.9 magnifications).

d d

Designation in 0.5 magnification units : 0 or 5 (5 to 9, up to 1 magnification) Designation in magnifications : 0 to 9

e: Character vertical magnification 1 to 9 (in magnifications)

* Two-digit designation enables the magnifications in 0.5 units (05 ~ 95: 0.5 to 9.5 magnifications).

The magnification can be designated in 0.1 units between 0.5 to 1. (06 ~ 09: 0.6 to 0.9 magnifications).

e e

Designation in 0.5 magnification units : 0 or 5 (5 to 9, up to 1 magnification) Designation in magnifications : 0 to 9

ff: Type of font 203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head A: Times Roman (Medium) 12 point 8 point

B: Times Roman (Medium) 15 point 10 point C: Times Roman (Bold) 15 point 10 point D: Times Roman (Bold) 18 point 12 point E: Times Roman (Bold) 21 point 14 point F: Times Roman (Italic) 18 point 12 point G: Helvetica (Medium) 9 point 6 point H: Helvetica (Medium) 15 point 10 point I: Helvetica (Medium) 18 point 12 point J: Helvetica (Bold) 18 point 12 point K: Helvetica (Bold) 21 point 14 point L: Helvetica (Italic) 18 point 12 point M: Presentation (Bold) 27 point 18 point N: Letter Gothic (Medium) 14.3 point 9.5 point O: Prestige Elite (Medium) 10.5 point 7 point P: Prestige Elite (Bold) 15 point 10 point

- 49 -

Page 54: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Q: Courier (Medium) 15 point 10 point R: Courier (Bold) 18 point 12 point S: OCR-A 12 point 12 point T: OCR-B 12 point 12 point a: Reserved to p: Reserved q: Gothic 725 Black

01 (a): Writable character 1 (1×1 dot to 720×720 dots) to 40 (a): Writable character 40 (1×1 dot to 720×720 dots) 51 (a): 2-byte code set writable character 1 (1×1 dot to 720×720 dots) to 55 (a): 2-byte code set writable character 5 (1×1 dot to 720×720 dots) a: Drive

(Omissible. If omitted, flash ROM on the CPU board is selected.) 0: Flash ROM on the CPU board * Fonts A to L, and q are proportional fonts.

ghh: Fine adjustment of character-to-character space (Omissible. If omitted, space is adjusted according to the designated font.)

g: Designates whether to increase or decrease the character-to-character space. +: Increase −: Decrease

hh: No. of space dots between characters 00 to 99 (in units of dots)

ii: Rotational angles of a character and character string 00: 0° (char.) 0° (char.-string) 11: 90° (char.) 90° (char.-string) 22: 180° (char.) 180° (char.-string) 33: 270° (char.) 270° (char.-string)

j: Character attribution B: Black character W (aabb): Reverse character

aa: No. of dots from the character string to the end of the black background in the horizontal direction

bb: No. of dots from the character string to the end of the black background in the vertical direction

aa: 01 to 99 (in units of dots) bb: 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

F (aabb): Boxed character aa: No. of dots from the character string area to the box in the

horizontal direction bb: No. of dots from the character string area to the box in the vertical

direction aa: 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

bb: 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

- 50 -

Page 55: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

C (aa): Stroked out character aa: No. of dots from the character string area to the end of the stroke aa: 01 to 99 (in units of dots) * Descriptions in parentheses are omissible.

(If omitted, it is character magnification (horizontal or vertical magnifications, whichever is larger) × 6 dots.)

Jkkll: Bold character designation (Omissible. If omitted, this process is not performed.)

kk: No. of horizontal shift dots 00 to 16 (in units of dots)

ll: No. of vertical shift dots 00 to 16 (in units of dots)

Mm: Type of check digits to be attached. (Omissible. If omitted, this process is not performed)

m: Type of check digit

0: Modulus 10 (Draws data and check digit) 1: Modulus 43 (Draws data and check digit) 2: DBP Modulus 10 (Draws data and check digit)

noooooooooo: Increment and decrement

(Omissible. When omitted, incrementing/decrementing is not performed.)

n: Designates whether to increment or decrement.

+: Increment -: Decrement

oooooooooo: Skip value 0000000000 to 9999999999

Zpp: Zero suppression (Omissible. When omitted, zero suppression is not performed.)

pp: No. of digits after zero suppression 00 to 20

Pq: Alignment (Omissible, When omitted, the alignment is set to left.)

q: Designates the character position

1: Left 2: Center 3: Right

4aaaa: Justification

aaaa: Character string area of X direction 0050 to 1040 (in 0.1 mm units)

5aaaabbbcc: Automatic line feed aaaa: Character string area of X direction

0050 to 1040 (in 0.1 mm units) bbb: Line feed spacing 010 to 500 (in 1 mm units)

cc: Number of lines 01 to 99

- 51 -

Page 56: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

rrr------rrr: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 255 digits

ss1, ss2, ss3, ------, ss20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can be also used.) Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

Explanation (1) Character string number

When drawing by the Data Command ([ESC] RC), the format designated by the character string number is selected.

(2) Print origin of coordinates

[Printing direction: Bottom first] [Printing direction: Top first]

The print origin of coordinates must be set so that the characters are drawn within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D).

[Effective print area] [mm] Model 203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Print head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Print head width 104.0 mm 105.7 mm G: Effective print width Min. 10.0 10.0 Max. 104.0 105.7

Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0 Label

Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 --- 11.0 8.0 --- 11.0

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 --- 997.0 997.0 --- 997.0

Label

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y Paper feed direction0X

Y

Backing paper

Effective print length

Effective print width

Effective print width

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Print origin of coordinates

Print origin of coordinates

Effective print length

Label

Backing paper

Sample

- 52 -

Page 57: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3) Horizontal magnification and vertical magnification

- 53 -

Char. height

Char. width

Point of origin

Horizontal spacing/ proportional spacing

Left offset Point of origin of next char.

Enlarge

Char. height × Vertical magnification

Char. Width × Horizontal magnification

(Horizontal spacing/proportional spacing) × Horizontal magnification

Point of origin

Point of origin of next char.

[Relationship between drawing coordinates and magnification]

Vertical magnification

Vertical magnification

Horizontal magnification

Horizontal magnification

Page 58: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(4) Type of font

A: Times Roman:

B: Times Roman

C: Times Roman

D: Times Roman

E: Times Roman

F: Times Roman

G: Helvetica

H: Helvetica

I: Helvetica

J: Helvetica

K: Helvetica

L: Helvetica

M: Presentation

N: Letter Gothic

O: Prestige Elite

P: Prestige Elite

Q: Courier

R: Courier

S: OCR-A

T: OCR-B

q: Gothic 725 Black

- 54 -

Page 59: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(5) Fine adjustment of character-to-character space

If no character-to-character space is specified or the number of space dots between characters is 0, drawing will take place according to the horizontal spacing/proportional spacing determined for each character. When character-to-character space is specified, drawing will take place according to the value obtained by adding the character spacing/proportional spacing to the specified value.

Point of origin

(Horizontal spacing/proportional spacing) × Horizontal magnification

Point of origin of next char.

No. of fine adjust space dots between characters

(6) Rotational angles of a character and character string

(7) Selection of character attribution

Origin

0° (00) 90° (11) 180° (22) 270° (33)

Sample

No. of dots in the horizontal direction

Black characters

BA BANo. of dots in the vertical direction

Reverse characters

B A

No. of dots in the horizontal direction

No. of dots in the vertical direction

No. of dots in the horizontal direction

BAStroked out characters Boxed characters

- 55 -

Page 60: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(8) Bold character designation

0° 90°

Horizontally bold

Vertically bold

Vertically/ horizontally

bold

Horizontally bold

Vertically bold

Vertically/ horizontally

bold

(9) Check digit to be attached

When Modulus 10 or Modulus 43 is selected, the check digit of a data row is calculated and attached to the data row for drawing. In case of Modulus 10, when the data includes any data other than numerals, drawing is not performed. In case of Modulus 43, when the data includes any data other than CODE39, drawing is not performed, either.

When DBP Modulus 10 is selected, the check digit of a data row is calculated and only the check digit is drawn. When the data includes any data other than numerals, drawing is not performed. When the font type is e, j, v, or w, the check digit cannot be designated. (Even if it is designated, it is ignored, and the printer operates as if there was no designation.)

* DBP Modulus 10 is Modulus 10 for Deutsche Bundespost Postdienst only.

(10) Increment/decrement

Printing is performed while the data is incremented or decremented every time a label is issued. When the data row exceeds the maximum number of digits (40), the data row will not be drawn. When the font type is e, j, v, w, 51, 52, 53, 54, or 55, the incrementing/decrementing cannot be designated. (Even if it is designated, it is ignored, and the printer operates as if there was no designation.)

Initial value 0000 0000 0000 0000 999999 INC/DEC +10 +10 +10 +10 +1

Zero suppression Not designated 5 3 0 3

1st label 0000 0000 000 0000 999999 2nd label 0010 0010 010 0010 000 3rd label 0020 0020 020 0020 001 4th label 0030 0030 030 0030 002 5th label 0040 0040 040 0040 003

- 56 -

Page 61: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Letters and numerals for increment/decrement

For the data string, up to 40 digits (including letters, numerals, and symbols) are possible. Only the numerals are picked up and calculated for incrementing/decrementing, and then are returned to the previous position to draw the data.

Example of increment/decrement calculation

Initial value 00000 A0A0A 7A8/9 A2A0A INC/DEC +1 +1 +3 -3 1st label 00000 A0A0A 7A8/9 A2A0A 2nd label 00001 A0A1A 7A9/2 A1A7A 3rd label 00002 A0A2A 7A9/5 A1A4A 4th label 00003 A0A3A 7A9/8 A1A1A 5th label 00004 A0A4A 8A0/1 A0A8A

(11) Zero suppression No. of digits after zero suppression 0 1 2 2 3 4 5

Data 0000 0000 0000 0A12 0123 0123 0123

Print 0000 0 00 A12 123 0123 0123

Zero(s) innumber orow, the dthe maxim51, 52, 5the printe

(12) A

If characters are not placed on one line when the justification and the automatic line feed

ace. When characters are not placed

, repeatedly decrease the value of the

a data row is replaced with a space(s) from the upper digits, according to the designated f digits. However, if the number of digits after zero suppression is greater than the data ata row will be drawn without performing zero suppression. Where the data row exceeds um number of digits (40), the data row will not be drawn. When the font type is e, j, v, w,

3, 54 or 55, zero suppression is not designated. (Even if it is designated, it is ignored, and r operates as if there was no designation.)

lignment

No. of dots

Right J u s t i f yCenter

Automatic line feed

Automatic line feed

Automatic line feed

Left

of character string area in the X direction

Designated origin

Line feed spacing No. of lines

are designated, the following steps are performed.

Decrease the value of the character-to-character spon one line even if the value is set to 0, return the value to its default, and then reduce the horizontal magnification for a character by 0.5.

If characters are still not placed on one linecharacter-to-character space, and then reduce the horizontal magnification. When characters are not placed on one line if the character magnification is set to 0.5 and the character-to-character space is set to 0, the field is not drawn. (The same previous field is also not drawn.)

- 57 -

Page 62: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(13) Data string to be printed

Drawing data can be programmed by designating the number of digits after the symbol “=.” Up to 255 digits of characters can be printed. When the type of font is e, j, v, or w, the maximum number of characters is 127. If the number of digits exceeds 255, the excessive data will be discarded.

For the character code table, refer to the character code table mentioned later.

(14) Link field No.

The link field No. can be programmed by designating it after the symbol “;”. After the link field No. is designated using the Format Command, the data strings are linked by the Link Field Data Command to draw an image.

Up to 20 fields can be linked.

The following shows an example of linked fields on the two continuous labels.

[Format Command]

[ESC] PC01; ........................ ; 01 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 1 is designated. [ESC] PC02; ........................ ; 03 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 3 is designated. [ESC] PC03; ........................ ; 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 4 is designated. [ESC] XB01;................... ; 03, 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link fields No. 3 and No. 4 are

designated. [ESC] PC04; ........................ ; 02 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 2 is designated. [ESC] PC05; ........................ ; 03 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 3 is designated. [ESC] PC06; ........................ ; 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 4 is designated. [ESC] XB02;................... ; 03, 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link fields No. 3 and No. 4 are

designated. Designating link field No. [Data Command]

[ESC] RC; A [LF] B [LF] ABCD [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] Link field No. 4 Link field No. 3 Link field No. 2 Link field No. 1

A

ABCD 001

*ABCD001*

B

ABCD 001

*ABCD001*

- 58 -

Page 63: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes

(1) Attachment of the check digit, increment/decrement, and zero suppression are performed according to the following priority. If any of the conditions is improper, no drawing will take place.

For example, the zero(s) is replaced with a space(s) as a result of zero suppression, but the modulus 10 designated to be attached cannot be calculated.

Increment/decrement > zero suppression > attachment of check digit

(2) Up to 32 fields for which incrementing/decrementing has been designated can be drawn. If the total of bit map font, outline font or bar code increment/decrement fields exceeds 32, drawing will take place without incrementing/decrementing any excessive field. The field to be incremented or decremented is kept incremented or decremented until the Image Buffer Clear Command ([ESC] C) is transmitted.

[Example]

1) Format Command (Increment character string No. 001 (+1)) 2) Format Command (No incrementing for character string No. 002) 3) Format Command (Increment character string No. 003 (+2)) 4) Image Buffer Clear Command 5) Data Command (Character string No. 001 “0001”) 6) Data Command (Character string No. 002 “AB-”) 7) Data Command (Character string No. 003 “0100”) 8) Issue Command (2 labels)

0001

AB - 0100

0002

AB - 0102

9) Issue Command (1 label)

0003

AB - 0104

10) Image Buffer Clear Command 11) Data Command (Character string No. 002 “00000”) 12) Issue Command (1 label)

00000

- 59 -

Page 64: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3) The Bit Map Font Format Command may be connected to the Outline Font Format Command when transmitted.

[ESC] P C001; 0100, 0150, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] C002; 0350, 0180, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] C005; 0200, 0300, 25, 2, C, +05, 00, B, +0000000001 [LF] V01; 0500, 0400, 0100, 0100, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL]

(4) In case that the drawing data differs for every label, the field of the drawing data for the previous label is automatically cleared using the character string number, then the next drawing data is printed. Therefore, the character string number should be designated so that they differ according to the drawing fields. Since the automatic field clear is not performed between the Clear Command ([ESC] C) and Issue Command ([ESC] XS), the fixed data may be drawn using the same character string number. In this case, the Format Command and Data Command should be sent alternately. (After the Issue Command is sent, the fields with the same character string number are automatically cleared until the Clear Command is sent.)

(5) The link field designation is cleared by omitting the link field designation using the same character string No. and reformatting data.

The link field designation can be also cleared by the Image Buffer Clear Command.

(6) A print data string and link field No. cannot be programmed at the same time.

Refer to Bit Map Font Data Command ([ESC] RC) Outline Font Format Command ([ESC] PV) Bar Code Format Command ([ESC] XB)

- 60 -

Page 65: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

12.5mm

S a m p l e

55.0mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Effective print area

Origin (0, 0)

(1)

A B C D

30.0mm

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC000; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, A, 00, B=ABCD [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0125, 1, 1, C, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC002; 0650, 0550, 2, 2, G, 33, B, +0000000001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC002; 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 61 -

Page 66: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

30.0mm

55.0mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Effective print area

Origin (0, 0) (2)

S 0 0 1

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, C, 00, B; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B; 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0550, 3, 1, 03, 03, 08, 08, 03, 0, 0150; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC; S [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 62 -

Page 67: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.9 OUTLINE FONT FORMAT COMMAND [ESC] PV

Function Sets the format to indicate where and how the outline font is to be printed.

Fonts other than TrueType font

Format [ESC] PVaa; bbbb, cccc, dddd, eeee, f (, ghhh), ii, j (, Mk) (, lmmmmmmmmmm) (, Znn) (, Po) (=ppp------ppp) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] PVaa; bbbb, cccc, dddd, eeee, f (, ghhh), ii, j (, Mk) (, lmmmmmmmmmm) (, Znn) (, Po) (; qq1, qq2, qq3, ------, qq20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Character string number 00 to 99

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of character string Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of character string 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

dddd: Character width 0020 to 0850 (in 0.1 mm units)

eeee: Height of the character 0020 to 0850 (in 0.1 mm units)

f: Type of font A: TEC FONT1 (Helvetica [bold]) B: TEC FONT1 (Helvetica [bold] proportional) E: Price Font 1 F: Price Font 2 G: Price Font 3 H: DUTCH801 Bold (Times Roman Proportional) I: BRUSH738 Regular (Pop Proportional) J: GOTHIC725 Black (Proportional)

ghhh: Fine adjustment of character-to-character space (Omissible. When omitted, the space is adjusted according to the designated font.)

g: Designates whether to increase or decrease the character-to-character space. +: Increase −: Decrease

hhh: No. of space dots between characters 000 to 512 (in units of dots)

ii: Rotational angles of a character and character string 00: 0° (char.) 0° (char.-string) 11: 90° (char.) 90° (char.-string) 22: 180° (char.) 180° (char.-string) 33: 270° (char.) 270° (char.-string)

- 63 -

Page 68: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

j: Character attribution B: Black character W (aabb): Reverse character

aa: No. of dots from the character string to the end of the black background in the horizontal direction.

bb: No. of dots from the character string to the end of the black background in the vertical direction.

aa: 01 to 99 (in units of dots) bb: 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

F (aabb): Boxed character

aa: No. of dots from the character string area to the box in the horizontal direction.

bb: No. of dots from the character string area to the box in the vertical direction.

aa: 01 to 99 (in units of dots) bb: 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

C (aa): Stroked out character

aa: No. of dots from the character string area to the end of the stroke

aa: 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

* Parameter in parentheses are omissible. (If omitted, it is character size (the character width or height, whichever is greater) ÷ 8 dots.)

Mk: Type of the check digit to be attached (Omissible. When omitted, the check digit is not drawn.) k: Type of check digit 0: Modulus 10 (Draws data and check digit) 1: Modulus 43 (Draws data and check digit) 2: DBP Modulus 10 (Draws check digit only)

lmmmmmmmmmm: Increment and decrement (Omissible. When omitted, incrementing/decrementing is not performed.)

l: Designates whether to increment or decrement. +: Increment −: Decrement

mmmmmmmmmm: Skip value 0000000000 to 9999999999

Znn: Zero suppression (Omissible. When omitted, zero suppression is not performed.) nn: No. of digits after zero suppression 00 to 20

- 64 -

Page 69: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Po: Alignment (Omissible. When omitted, the alignment is set to the left.)

o: Designates the character position.

1: Left 2: Center 3: Right 4aaaa: Justification

aaaa: X direction of character string area 0050 to 1040 (in 0.1 mm units)

ppp------ppp: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 255 digits

qq1, qq2, qq3, ------, qq20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

- 65 -

Page 70: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

TrueType font

Format [ESC] PVaa; bbbb, cccc, dddd, eeee, ff, g (, hiii), jj, k (=ppp ------ ppp) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Character string number 00 to 99

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of character string Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of character string 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

dddd: Character width 0020 to 0850 (in 0.1 mm units)

eeee: Height of the character 0020 to 0850 (in 0.1 mm units)

ff: Type of font 01: BalloonPExtBol (File name: Ballp_eb.ttf) 02: BlacklightD (File name: Blklt_rg.ttf) 03: BrushScrD (File name: Brush_rg.ttf) 04: CG Times (File name: Tec_cgt.ttf) 05: CG Times Bold (File name: Tec_cgtb.ttf) 06: CG Times Italic (File name: Tec_cgti.ttf) 07: Clarendon Condensed Bold (File name: Tec_clcd.ttf) 08: FlashPBol (File name: Flash_bd.ttf) 09: Garamond Kursiv Halbfett (File name: Tec_gmkh.ttf) 10: GoudyHeaP (File name: Gdyhp_rg.ttf) 11: GilliesGotDBol (File name: Gilli_bd.ttf) 12: GilliesGotLig (File name: Gilli_lt.ttf) 13: NimbusSanNovTUltLigCon (File name: Nsnct_ul.ttf) 14: Ryahd (File name: ryahd.ttf) 15: Ryahd Bold (File name: ryahdbd.ttf) 16: CG Triumvirate (File name: Trium.ttf) 17: CG Triumvirate Condensed Bold (File name: Triumcb.ttf) 18: Univers Medium (File name: Tec_uni.ttf) 19: Univers Bold (File name: Tec_unib.ttf) 20: Univers Medium Italic (File name: Tec_unii.ttf) 21: add_on TrueTypeFont 1 22: add_on TrueTypeFont 2 23: add_on TrueTypeFont 3 24: add_on TrueTypeFont 4 25: add_on TrueTypeFont 5

(*1) The font types 21 to 25 are the fonts to be added by the user.

(*2) For the fonts stored in flash ROM on the CPU board, parameter “ff” for the type of font corresponds to the font type according to the setting made when fonts are stored.

- 66 -

Page 71: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

g: Drive (Omissible. When omitted, files are stored in the flash ROM on the CPU board.) Indicates where the TrueType font files are stored.

0: Flash ROM on the CPU board

hiii: Fine adjustment of character-to-character space (Omissible. When omitted, the space is adjusted according to the designated font.)

h: Designates whether to increase or decrease the character-to-character space. +: Increase −: Decrease

iii: No. of space dots between characters 000 to 512 (in units of dots)

jj: Rotational angles of a character and character string 00: 0° (char.) 0° (char.-string) 11: 90° (char.) 90° (char.-string) 22: 180° (char.) 180° (char.-string) 33: 270° (char.) 270° (char.-string)

k: Character attribution B: Black character

ppp------ppp: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 255 digits

* TrueType fonts are not included in the standard character generator data. Therefore, they must be installed in flash ROM on the CPU board. For installation of TrueType font and details, refer to the TrueType Font Specification (TAA-1416).

* If Arabic is selected as the character code, letters are written from right to left.

Origin

0° (00) 90° (11) 180° (22) 270° (33)

- 67 -

Page 72: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Explanation (1) Character string number When drawing by the Data Command ([ESC] RV), the format designated by the

character string number is selected.

(2) Print origin of coordinates

Label

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y Paper feed direction

0X

Y

Backing paper

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

Effective print length

Effective print width

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

[Printing direction: Bottom first] [Printing direction: Top first]

Print origin of coordinates

• The print origin of coordinates must be set so the character drawing result will be within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D).

[Effective print area] [mm] Model

203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Print head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Print head width 104.0 mm 105.7 mm G: Effective print width Min. 10.0 10.0 Max. 104.0 105.7

Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0 Label

Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 --- 11.0 8.0 --- 11.0

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 --- 997.0 997.0 --- 997.0

Print origin of coordinates

Label

Backing paper

Sample

- 68 -

Page 73: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3) Character width and character height

Char.width

Char. height

Char. width

Char.height

Standard size (256 × 256 dots)

Char.width

Char. height

(4) Type of font

A: TEC FONT1 (Helvetica [bold])

B: TEC FONT1 (Helvetica [bold] proportional)

- 69 -

Page 74: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

E: Price font 1 (POP font)

F: Price font 2 (POP font)

G: Price font 3 (POP font)

H: DUTCH801 Bold (Times Roman Proportional)

- 70 -

Page 75: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

I: BRUSH 738 Regular (Pop Proportional)

J: GOTHIC725 Black

(5) Fine adjustment of character-to-character space

If no character-to-character space is specified or the number of space dots between characters is 0, drawing will take place according to the horizontal spacing/proportional spacing determined for each character. If character-to-character space is specified, drawing will take place according to the value obtained by adding the character spacing/proportional spacing to the specified value. When justify is selected for the alignment, the character-to-character space setting is invalid. (The horizontal spacing/proportional spacing is increased or decreased depending on the character size.)

A B C

A B

- 71 -

Page 76: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(6) Rotational angles of a character and character string

Origin

0° (00) 90° (11) 180° (22) 270° (33)

Sample

(7) Selection of character attribution

Black characters

BA

No. of dots in the horizontal direction

Reverse characters

No. of dots in the vertical direction BA

B A

No. of dots in the horizontal direction

No. of dots in the vertical direction

Boxed characters

No. of dots in the horizontal direction

BAStroked out characters

(8) Check digit to be attached

When Modulus 10 or Modulus 43 is selected, the check digit of a data row is calculated and attached to the data row for drawing. In case of Modulus 10, when the data includes any data other than numerals, drawing is not performed. In case of Modulus 43, when the data includes any data other than CODE39, drawing is not performed, either.

When DBP Modulus 10 is selected, the check digit of a data row is calculated and only the check digit is drawn. When the data includes any data other than numerals, drawing is not performed.

* DBP Modulus 10 is Modulus 10 for Deutsche Bundespost Postdienst only.

- 72 -

Page 77: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(9) Increment/decrement Printing is performed while the data is incremented or decremented each time a label is

issued. Where the data row exceeds the maximum number of digits (40), the data row will not be drawn.

Initial value 0000 0000 0000 0000 999999 INC/DEC +10 +10 +10 +10 +1

Zero suppression Not designated 5 3 0 3

1st label 0000 0000 000 0000 999999 2nd label 0010 0010 010 0010 000 3rd label 0020 0020 020 0020 001 4th label 0030 0030 030 0030 002 5th label 0040 0040 040 0040 003

Letters and numerals for increment/decrement

For the data string, up to 40 digits (including letters, numerals, and symbols) are possible. Only the numerals are selected and calculated for incrementing/ decrementing, and then are returned to the previous position to draw the data.

Example of increment/decrement calculation

Initial value 00000 A0A0A 7A8/9 A2A0A INC/DEC +1 +1 +3 -3 1st label 00000 A0A0A 7A8/9 A2A0A 2nd label 00001 A0A1A 7A9/2 A1A7A 3rd label 00002 A0A2A 7A9/5 A1A4A 4th label 00003 A0A3A 7A9/8 A1A1A 5th label 00004 A0A4A 8A0/1 A0A8A

(10) Zero suppression

No. of digits after zero suppression 0 1 2 2 3 4 5

Data 0000 0000 0000 0A12 0123 0123 0123Print 0000 0 00 A12 123 0123 0123

Zero(s) in a data row is replaced with a space(s) from the upper digits, according to the designated number of digits. However, if the number of digits after zero suppression is greater than the data row, the data row will be drawn without performing zero suppression. Where the data row exceeds the maximum number of digits (40), the data row will not be drawn.

(11) Alignment

If characters are not placed on one line when justification is designated, the width is

calculated automatically. When the width is less than the limit value (2 mm) for the outline font, that field is not drawn. (The same previous field is not drawn.)

Right

Character string length in the X direction (in 0.1 mm units)

J u s t i Center Left Origin

- 73 -

Page 78: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(12) Data string to be printed Drawing data can be programmed by designating the number of digits after the symbol

“=.” Up to 255 digits can be printed. When the type of font is 26, 27, 28, 29, or 30, the maximum number of characters is 127. When the number of digits exceeds the maximum value, the excessive data will be discarded. For the character code table, refer to chapter 12 “CHARACTER CODE TABLE”.

(13) Link field No.

The link field No. can be programmed by designating it after the symbol “;.” After the link field No. is designated using the Format Command, the data strings are linked by the Link Field Data Command to draw an image.

Up to 20 fields can be linked.

The following shows an example of linked fields on the two continuous labels.

[Format Command]

[ESC] PV01; ........................ ; 01 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 1 is designated. [ESC] PV02; ........................ ; 03 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 3 is designated. [ESC] PV03; ........................ ; 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 4 is designated. [ESC] XB01;................... ; 03, 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link fields No. 3 and No. 4 are

designated. [ESC] PV04; ........................ ; 02 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 2 is designated. [ESC] PV05; ........................ ; 03 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 3 is designated. [ESC] PV06; ........................ ; 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 4 is designated. [ESC] XB02;................... ; 03, 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link fields No. 3 and No. 4 are

designated. Designating the link field No. [Data Command]

[ESC] RV; A [LF] B [LF] ABCD [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] Link field No. 4 Link field No. 3 Link field No. 2 Link field No. 1

A

ABCD 001

*ABCD001*

B

ABCD 001

*ABCD001*

- 74 -

Page 79: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes (1) The check digit attachment, increment/decrement, and zero suppression are performed according to the following priority. If any of the conditions are improper, no drawing will take place.

For example, the zero(s) is replaced by a space(s) as a result of zero suppression, but the modulus 10 designated to be attached cannot be calculated.

Increment/decrement > zero suppression > attachment of check digit

(2) Up to 32 fields for which incrementing/decrementing has been designated can be drawn. If the total bit map font, outline font, and bar code increment/decrement fields exceeds 32, drawing will take place without incrementing/decrementing any excessive field. The field to be incremented or decremented is incremented or decremented until the Image Buffer Clear Command ([ESC] C) is transmitted.

[Examples]

1) Format Command (Increment character string No. 01 (+1)) 2) Format Command (No incrementing for character string No. 02) 3) Format Command (Increment character string No. 03 (+2)) 4) Image Buffer Clear Command 5) Data Command (Character string No. 01 “0001”) 6) Data Command (Character string No. 02 “AB-”) 7) Data Command (Character string No. 03 “0100”) 8) Issue Command (2 labels)

AB-0100 0001

AB-0102 0002

9) Issue Command (1 label)

AB-0104

0003 10) Image Buffer Clear Command 11) Data Command (Character string No. 02 “00000”) 12) Issue Command (1 label)

00000

(3) The Outline Font Format Command may be connected to the Bit Map Font Format

Command when transmitted. [ESC] PC001; 0100, 0150, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF]

C002; 0350, 0180, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] C005; 0200, 0300, 25, 2, C, +05, 00, B, +0000000001 [LF] V01; 0500, 0400, 0100, 0100, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL]

- 75 -

Page 80: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(4) When the drawing data differs for every label, the drawing data field for the previous label is automatically cleared using the character string number, then the next drawing data is printed. Therefore, the character string number should be designated so that they differ according to the drawing fields. Since the automatic field clear is not performed between the Clear Command ([ESC] C) and Issue Command ([ESC] XS), the fixed data may be drawn using the same character string number. In this case, the Format Command and Data Command should be sent alternately. (After the Issue Command is sent, the fields with the same character string number are automatically cleared until the Clear Command is sent.)

(5) When characters overlap due to the character-to-character space fine adjustment, the outline font is not painted properly. Program the fine adjustment value so that characters will not overlap. Also, when drawings such as lines or characters are positioned over the outline font area, the outline font is not painted properly. For font types A and B, the fine adjustment value should be set so that other drawings do not overlap the area in which the outline font is to be drawn. For font types C, E, F and G, the fine adjustment value should be set so that other drawings do not overlap the area of the designated character width and height.

(6) The link field designation can be cleared by omitting the link field designation using the same character string No. and reformatting data.

The link field designation can also be cleared by the Image Buffer Clear Command.

(7) A print data string and the link field No. cannot be programmed at the same time.

Refer to Outline Font Data Command ([ESC] RV) Bit Map Font Format Command ([ESC] PC) Bar Code Format Command ([ESC] XB)

- 76 -

Page 81: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples Origin (0, 0)

12.5mm

S a m p l e

55.0mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Effective print area

(1)

A B C D

30.0mm

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV00; 0200, 0300, 0080, 0080, B, 00, B=ABCD [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0200, 0125, 0100, 0100, B, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV02; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B, +0000000001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RV01; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RV02; 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 77 -

Page 82: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(2) Origin (0, 0)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, C, 00, B; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B; 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0550, 3, 1, 03, 03, 08, 08, 03, 0, 0150; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RV; S [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

30.0mm

Effective print area

55.0mm

20.0 mm

S 0 0 1

65.0 mm

- 78 -

Page 83: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.10 BAR CODE FORMAT COMMAND [ESC] XB

Function Sets the format to indicate where and how the bar code is to be printed and how it is to be printed.

In the case of WPC, CODE93, CODE128, UCC/EAN128, Customer bar code, POSTNET, RM4SCC, KIX CODE

(WPC is the generic name for bar codes of JAN, EAN and UPC.)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, k, llll (, mnnnnnnnnnn, ooo, p, qq) (= sss ------ sss) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, k, llll (, mnnnnnnnnnn, ooo, p, qq) (; tt1, tt2, tt3, ------, tt20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code 0: JAN8, EAN8 5: JAN13, EAN13 6: UPC-E 7: EAN13 + 2 digits 8: EAN13 + 5 digits 9: CODE128 (with auto code selection) A: CODE128 (without auto code selection) C: CODE93 G: UPC-E + 2 digits H: UPC-E + 5 digits I: EAN8 + 2 digits J: EAN8 + 5 digits K: UPC-A L: UPC-A + 2 digits M: UPC-A + 5 digits N: UCC/EAN128 R: Customer bar code (Postal code for Japan) S: Highest priority customer bar code (Postal code for Japan) U: POSTNET (Postal code for U.S) V: RM4SCC (ROYAL MAIL 4 STATE CUSTOMER CODE) (Postal code for U.K) W: KIX CODE (Postal code for Belgium) b: GTIN

- 79 -

Page 84: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

e: Type of check digit

1: Without attaching check digit

2: Check digit check WPC Modulus 10 CODE93 Modulus 47 CODE128 PSEUDO 103

3: Check digit automatic attachment (1) WPC Modulus 10 CODE93 Modulus 47 CODE128 PSEUDO 103 UCC/EAN128 Modulus 10 + Modulus 103 Customer code Special check digit POSTNET Special check digit RM4SCC Special check digit

4: Check digit automatic attachment (2) WPC Modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits

5: Check digit automatic attachment (3) WPC Modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits

* For the Customer bar code, POSTNET, and RMC4SCC, only “3: Check digit auto attachment (1)” is effective.

ff: 1-module width 01 to 15 (in units of dots)

k: Rotational angle of bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

llll: Height of the bar code 0000 to 1000 (in 0.1 mm units)

For the Customer bar code, POSTNET, RMC4SCC, and KIX CODE, the height of the long bar is specified.

mnnnnnnnnnn: Increment/decrement (Omissible. When omitted, incrementing/decrementing is not performed.)

m: Indicates whether to increment or decrement +: Increment −: Decrement

nnnnnnnnnn: Skip value 0000000000 to 9999999999

ooo: Length of WPC guard bar (Omissible. When omitted, the guard bar is not extended.) 000 to 100 (in 0.1 mm units)

p: Selection of print or non-print of numerals under bars (Omissible. When omitted, the numerals under the bars are not printed.) 0: Non-print 1: Print

- 80 -

Page 85: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

qq: No. of digits after zero suppression (Omissible. When omitted, zero suppression is not performed.) 00 to 20

sss ------ sss: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 126 digits. However, it varies depending on the type of bar code.

tt1, tt2, tt3, ------. tt20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

* Omissible parameters (such as “Increment/decrement”, “Selection of print or non-print of numerals under bars” and “No. of digits after zero suppression”) cannot be set when the Customer bar code, POSTNET, RM4SCC, or KIX CODE is selected.

- 81 -

Page 86: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of MSI, Interleaved 2 of 5, CODE39, NW7, Industrial 2 of 5, MATRIX 2 of 5 for NEC

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, gg, hh, ii, jj, k, llll (, mnnnnnnnnnn, p, qq) (, r) (=sss------sss) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, gg, hh, ii, jj, k, llll (, mnnnnnnnnnn, p, qq) (, r) (; tt1, tt2, tt3, ------, tt20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code 1: MSI 2: Interleaved 2 of 5 (ITF) 3: CODE39 (standard) 4: NW7 B: CODE39 (full ASCII) O: Industrial 2 of 5 a: MATRIX 2 of 5 for NEC

e: Type of check digit 1: Without attaching check digit

2: Check digit check CODE39 Modulus 43 MSI IBM modulus 10 ITF Modulus 10 Industrial 2 of 5 Modulus check character MATRIX 2 of 5 for NEC Modulus check character

3: Check digit automatic attachment (1) CODE39 Modulus 43 MSI IBM modulus 10 ITF Modulus 10 Industrial 2 of 5 Modulus check character MATRIX 2 of 5 for NEC Modulus check character

4: Check digit automatic attachment (2) MSI IBM modulus 10 + IBM modulus 10 ITF DBP Modulus 10

5: Check digit automatic attachment (3) MSI IBM modulus 11 + IBM modulus 10

ff: Narrow bar width 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

gg: Narrow space width 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

* In the case of industrial 2 of 5, designate an element-to-element space.

hh: Wide bar width 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

- 82 -

Page 87: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

ii: Wide space width 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

* In the case of industrial 2 of 5, the value is fixed to 00.

jj: Character-to-character space width 01 to 99 (in units of dots)

* In the case of MSI and ITF, character-to-character space width is fixed to 00.

k: Rotational angle of bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

llll: Height of bar code 0000 to 1000 (in 0.1 mm units)

mnnnnnnnnnn: Increment/decrement (Omissible. When omitted, incrementing/decrementing is not performed.)

m: Indicates whether to increment or decrement +: Increment -: Decrement

nnnnnnnnnn: Skip value 0000000000 to 9999999999

p: Selection of print or non-print of numerals under bars (Omissible. When omitted, the numerals under the bars are not printed.)

0: Non-print 1: Print

qq: No. of digits after zero suppression (Omissible. When omitted, zero suppression is not performed.) 00 to 20

r: Designates the attachment of start/stop code (Omissible. When omitted, the start/stop code is automatically attached.)

T: Attachment of start code only P: Attachment of stop code only N: Start/stop code unattached

sss------sss: Data string to be printed (Omissible)

Max. 126 digits. However, the number of digits varies depending on the type of bar code.

tt1, tt2, tt3, ------, tt20: Link field No. (Omissible)

01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

- 83 -

Page 88: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of RSS (Reduced Space Symbology)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, g, hhhh (, ijjjjjjjjjj, kk) (= sss ------ sss) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, g, hhhh (, ijjjjjjjjjj, kk) (; tt1, tt2, tt3, ------, tt20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code b: RSS family

e: Version (Type of RSS) 1: RSS-14 2: RSS-14 Stacked 3: RSS-14 Stacked Omnidirectional 4: RSS Limited 5: RSS Expanded 6: RSS Expanded Stacked

ff: 1-module width 01 to 15 (in units of dots)

g: Rotational angle of bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

hhhh: Height of bar code 0000 to 1000 (in 0.1 mm units)

ijjjjjjjjjj: Increment/decrement (Omissible. When omitted, incrementing/decrementing is not performed.)

i: Indicates whether to increment or decrement +: Increment -: Decrement

jjjjjjjjjj: Skip value 0000000000 to 9999999999

kk: No. of digits after zero suppression (Omissible. When omitted, zero suppression is not performed.) 00 to 20

sss ------ sss: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 126 digits. However, it varies depending on the type of bar code.

tt1, tt2, tt3, ------. tt20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

- 84 -

Page 89: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of Data Matrix (Two-dimensional code)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, ee, ff, gg, h (, Ciiijjj) (, Jkkllmmmnnn) (= ooo ------ooo) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, ee, ff, gg, h (, Ciiijjj) (, Jkkllmmmnnn) (; pp1, pp2, pp3, ------, pp20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code Q: Data Matrix (Two-dimensional code)

ee: ECC type 00: ECC0 01: ECC50 04: ECC50 05: ECC50 06: ECC80 07: ECC80 08: ECC80 09: ECC100 10: ECC100 11: ECC140 12: ECC140 13: ECC140 14: ECC140 20: ECC200

ff: 1-cell width 00 to 99 (in units of dots)

gg: Format ID 01: Format ID 1 02: Format ID 2 03: Format ID 3 04: Format ID 4 05: Format ID 5 06: Format ID 6

* When ECC200 is designated as ECC type, the format ID designation is ignored. When format ID of 11 through 16 is designated, ECC200 is automatically selected (to ensure compatibility with the old model).

- 85 -

Page 90: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

h: Rotational angle of bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

Ciiijjj: No. of cells (Omissible. When omitted, it is automatically set.)

iii: No. of cells in the X direction 000 to 144

jjj: No. of cells in the Y direction 000 to 144

* Cell setting method varies according to the ECC type.

ECC0 to ECC140 ECC200 No. of cells to be designated

Odd numbers only Even numbers only

Min./Max. No. of cells 9 × 9 to 49 × 49 10 × 10 to 144 × 144Rectangular code None 18 × 8

32 × 8 26 × 12 36 × 12 36 × 16 48 × 16

• When this parameter is omitted, the number of cells is automatically set. Also, when any data other than the above values are designated for the number of cells in the X and Y directions, the number of cells are automatically set.

Jkkllmmmnnn: Connection setting (Omissible. When omitted, connection is not made.)

kk: Code number 01 to 16

ll: No. of divided codes 02 to 16

mmm: ID number 1 001 to 254

nnn: ID number 2 001 to 254

ooo ------ ooo: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 2000 digits.

pp1, pp2, pp3, ------, pp20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

- 86 -

Page 91: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of PDF417 (Two-dimensional code)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, ee, ff, gg, h, iiii (=jjj------jjj) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, ee, ff, gg, h, iiii (; kk1, kk2, kk3, ------, kk20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code P: PDF417 (Two-dimensional code)

ee: Security level 00: Level 0

01: Level 1 02: Level 2 03: Level 3 04: Level 4 05: Level 5 06: Level 6 07: Level 7 08: Level 8

ff: 1-module width 01 to 10 (in units of dots)

gg: No. of columns (strings) 01 to 30

h: Rotational angle of bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

iiii: Bar height 0000 to 0100 (in 0.1 mm units)

jjj-----jjj: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 2,000 digits

kk1, kk2, kk3, ------, kk20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.)

Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

- 87 -

Page 92: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of MicroPDF417 (Two-dimensional code)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, ee, ff, gg, h, iiii (=jjj------jjj) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, ee, ff, gg, h, iiii (; kk1, kk2, kk3, ------, kk20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code X: MicroPDF417 (Two-dimensional code)

ee: Security level

00: Fixed

ff: 1-module width 01 to 10 (in dots)

gg: No. of columns/rows 00 to 38

h: Rotational angle of bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

iiii: Bar height 0000 to 0100 (in 0.1 mm units)

jjj-----jjj: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 366 digits

kk1, kk2, kk3, ------, kk20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.)

Up to 20 fields can be designated using commas.

- 88 -

Page 93: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

The maximum number of columns and rows for the MicroPDF417

Parameter (gg) No. of columns No. of rows Max. number of digits

for binary mode Max. number of digits for

upper case letter/space mode Max. number of digits

for numeric mode

00 – – 150 250 366 01 1 – 22 38 55 02 2 – 43 72 105 03 3 – 97 162 237 04 4 – 150 250 366 05 11 3 6 8 06 14 7 12 17 07 1 17 10 18 26 08 20 13 22 32 09 24 18 30 44 10 28 22 38 55 11 8 8 14 20 12 11 14 24 35 13 14 21 36 52 14 2 17 27 46 67 15 20 33 56 82 16 23 38 64 93 17 26 43 72 105 18 6 6 10 14 19 8 10 18 26 20 10 15 26 38 21 12 20 34 49 22 3 15 27 46 67 23 20 39 66 96 24 26 54 90 132 25 32 68 114 167 26 38 82 138 202 27 44 97 162 237 28 4 8 14 20 29 6 13 22 32 30 8 20 34 49 31 10 27 46 67 32 12 34 58 85 33 4 15 45 76 111 34 20 63 106 155 35 26 85 142 208 36 32 106 178 261 37 38 128 214 313 38 44 150 250 366

“–” for parameter 00 to 04 indicates the numbers of columns/rows which are automatically set by the printer. In this case, the pattern which has a smaller number of code words is automatically selected. When the numbers of code words is equal, the smaller number of columns are selected.

- 89 -

Page 94: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of QR code (Two-dimensional code)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, g, h (, Mi) (, Kj) (, Jkkllmm) (= nnn --- nnn) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, g, h (, Mi) (, Kj) (, Jkkllmm) (; oo1, oo2, oo3 ------ oo20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code T: QR code (Two-dimensional code)

e: Designation of error correction level L: High density level M: Standard level Q: Reliability level H: High reliability level

ff: 1-cell width 00 to 52 (in units of dots)

g: Selection of mode M: Manual mode A: Automatic mode

h: Rotational angle of the bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

Mi: Selection of model (Omissible. When omitted, Model 1 is automatically selected.) i = 1: Model 1 2: Model 2

Kj: Mask number (Omissible. When omitted, the number is automatically set.) j = 0 to 7: Mask number 0 to 7 8: No mask

Jkkllmm: Connection setting (Omissible. When omitted, connection is not made.)

kk = 01 to 16: Value indicating which divided code is connected. ll = 01 to 16: Number of divided codes

mm = 00 to FF: A value for all print data (before devided) which have been XORed in units of bytes.

nnn --- nnn: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 2000 digits

oo1 --- oo20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 digits can be designated using commas.

- 90 -

Page 95: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of MaxiCode Code (Two-dimensional code)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d (, e) (, Jffgg) (, Zh) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code Z: MaxiCode (Two-dimensional code)

e: Mode selection (Omissible)

• When the MaxiCode specification is set to “TYPE1: Compatible with the current version” in the system mode.

Omitted: Mode 2 0: Mode 2 1: Mode 4 2: Mode 2 3: Mode 3 4: Mode 4 5: Mode 2 6: Mode 6 7: Mode 2 8: Mode 2 9: Mode 2

• When the MaxiCode specification is set to “TYPE2: Special specification” in the system mode.

Omitted: Mode 2 or Mode 3(*) 0: Mode 2 or Mode 3(*) 1: Mode 4 2: Mode 2 3: Mode 3 4: Mode 4 5: Mode 2 or Mode 3 (*) 6: Mode 6 7: Mode 2 or Mode 3 (*) 8: Mode 2 or MODE 3 (*) 9: Mode 2 or MODE 3 (*)

*: Mode 2 or Mode 3 should be determined depending on the country code of the data command. When the country code is 840, Mode 2 should be selected. For other codes than 840, Mode 3 should be selected.

Jffgg: Connection setting (Omissible. When omitted, connection is not made.) ff: Code number 01 to 08 gg: No. of divided codes 01 to 08

Zh: Attachment of Zipper block and Contrast block (Omissible. When omitted, they are not attached.)

h= 0: No attachment of Zipper block and Contrast block 1: Attachment of Zipper block and Contrast block 2: Attachment of Zipper block 3: Attachment of Contrast block

- 91 -

Page 96: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of CP code (Two-dimensional code)

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, g, h (, Ciijj) (= kkkk --- kkk) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, e, ff, g, h (, Ciijj) (; ll1, ll2, ll3, --- ll20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: X-coordinate of the print origin of bar code Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Y-coordinate of the print origin of bar code 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code Y: CP code (Two-dimensional code)

e: Designation of ECC (Error Correction Code) level 0: No designation 1: 10% 2: 20% 3: 30% 4: 40% 5: 50%

Only when the number of code characters are specified, “0” (No designation) can be selected. If “0 (No designation)” is selected without specifying the number of code characters, the CP code is not printed. When the number of code characters are specified, blank code areas created after the characters are encoded should all be filled with ECC characters.

ff: 1-cell width 00 to 99 (in units of dots)

g: No. of character bits 0: Automatically set A: 8 bits

Designates how many bits are used for representing a character. When “0” is designated, the optimal value is automatically set, according to

data.

h: Rotational angle of the bar code 0: 0° 1: 90° 2: 180° 3: 270°

Ciijj: No. of code characters (When omitted, it is automatically set.) ii = No. of characters in the X direction: 03 to 22 jj = No. of characters in the Y direction: 02 to 22

“Character” is a unit for code for encoding the CP code.

1 character occupies a 3×3-square block. When the value for “jj” is larger than that for “ii”, an error occurs.

The number of cells for the code is as follows. (No. of characters × 3 +2)

- 92 -

Page 97: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

kkkk --- kkk: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 473 digits

ll1, ll2, ll3, --- ll20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 digits can be designated using commas.

- 93 -

Page 98: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of RFID

Format [ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, (, Aeee) (= fff --- fff) [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XBaa; bbbb, cccc, d, (, Aeee) (; gg1, gg2, gg3, --- gg20) [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbbb: Parameter not referred to Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

cccc: Parameter not referred to 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

d: Type of bar code r: RFID

eee: Address where the data is written (Omissible) 000 to 999 Designates the address where data starts to be written. This parameter is effective only when ISO18000-6B tag is used. When omitted, it is set to 18.

fff --- fff: Data string to be printed (Omissible) Max. 512 digits However, it varies depending on the tag types.

gg1, gg2, gg3, --- gg20: Link field No. (Omissible) 01 to 99 (1 to 99 can also be used.) Up to 20 digits can be designated using commas.

- 94 -

Page 99: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Explanation (1) Bar code number

When drawing by the Data Command ([ESC] RB), the format designated by the bar code number is selected.

(2) Print origin of coordinates

Label

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y

Effective print

length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print width

[Printing direction: Bottom first]

Print origin of coordinates

Backing paper Backing paper

Paper feed direction0X

Y

Label

Effective print

length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0) Effective

print width

[Printing direction: Top first]

Print origin of coordinates

The print origin of coordinates must be set so that the bar code drawing result will be within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D).

[Effective print area] [mm] Model

203-dpi print head 300-dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Print head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Print head width 104.0 mm 105.7 mm

Min. 10.0 10.0 G: Effective print width

Max. 104.0 105.7 Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0

Label Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 --- 11.0 8.0 --- 11.0

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 --- 997.0 997.0 --- 997.0

- 95 -

Page 100: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3) Type of bar code

0: JAN8, EAN8 1: MSI

2: Interleaved 2 of 5 3: CODE39 (standard)

4: NW7 5: JAN13, EAN13

6: UPC-E 7: EAN13 + 2 digits

8: EAN13 +5 digits 9: A: CODE128

B: CODE39 (Full ASCII) C: CODE93

G: UPC-E + 2 digits H: UPC-E + 5 digits

I: EAN8 + 2 digits J: EAN8 + 5 digits

K: UPC-A L: UPC-A + 2 digits

- 96 -

Page 101: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

M: UPC-A + 5 digits N: UCC/EAN128

O: Industrial 2 of 5 P: PDF417

Q: Data Matrix R: Customer bar code

S: Highest priority customer bar code T: QR code

U: POSTNET V: RM4SCC

W: KIX code X: MicroPDF417

Y: CP Code Z: MaxiCode

- 97 -

Page 102: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

b: RSS family

RSS-14 RSS-14 Stacked

RSS-14 Stacked Omnidirectional RSS-14 Limited

RSS Expanded

RSS Expanded Stacked

(4) Type of check digit

When no check digit is attached, a bar code of the data row will be drawn.

In the case of the check digit check, when each check digit check is performed according to the type of bar code and results in normal, a bar code will be drawn. If the check digit is not proper, the bar code will not be drawn.

In case that the check digit is automatically attached, each check digit is attached according to the type of bar code when a bar code is drawn.

If the type of bar code is CODE93, CODE128 (with auto code selection), or UCC/EAN128, the check digit will always be attached regardless of the designation of the type of check digit.

If the type of bar code is JAN, EAN, or UPC, the designation of no check digit attachment automatically assumes the check digit check.

DBP Modulus 10 is Modulus 10 for Deutsche Bundespost Postdienst only.

- 98 -

Page 103: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(5) Bar width, space width, and character-to-character space

Designate the bar, space, and character-to-character space widths according to the type of bar code. Note that the proper value differs according to the rotational angle of bar code, type, number of digits, print speed, paper used, etc. Examples of such designations are listed below. (1 dot = 1/12 mm)

In case of JAN, EAN, UPC, CODE93, CODE128, UCC/EAN128, PDF417, or MicroPDF417, the width of 2 to 6 modules is automatically calculated by designating a 1-module width.

[Example of setting]

203-dpi print head

1 module 2 modules 3 modules 4 modules 5 modules 6 modulesType of bar code

Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space

JAN, EAN, UPC 3 6 9 12 - - CODE93 2 4 6 8 - - CODE128, EAN128 2 4 6 8 - - PDF417 2 4 6 8 10 12 MicroPDF417 2 4 6 8 10 12

Narrow Wide

Type of bar code Bar Space Bar Space

Character-to-character space

MSI 2 2 6 6 0 ITF 2 2 6 6 0 CODE39 2 2 6 6 2 NW7 2 2 6 6 2 Industrial 2 of 5 2 2 6 0 2 MATRIX 2 of 5 2 2 6 6 2

300-dpi print head

1 module 2 modules 3 modules 4 modules 5 modules 6 modulesType of bar code

Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space Bar Space

JAN, EAN, UPC 4 8 12 16 - - CODE93 3 6 9 12 - - CODE128, EAN128 3 6 9 12 - - PDF417 3 6 9 12 15 18 MicroPDF417 2 4 6 8 10 12

Narrow Wide

Type of bar code Bar Space Bar Space

Character-to-character space

MSI 3 3 8 8 0 ITF 3 3 8 8 0 CODE39 3 3 8 8 3 NW7 3 3 8 8 3 Industrial 2 of 5 3 3 8 0 3 MATRIX 2 of 5 3 3 8 8 3

When NW7 is used, transmission of the space character assumes a space equals to ‘a narrow space ×12 dots’. In this case, the space is max. 255 dots.

- 99 -

Page 104: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of Data Matrix or CP code

When 1-cell width is set to 00 for the Data Matrix or CP code, a two-dimensional code is not drawn. However, the bar code printed on the previous label is cleared.

1-cell width

1-cell width = 3

- 100 -

Page 105: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of QR code 1-cell width

1-cell width

When the 1-cell width is set to 0, a two-dimensional code is not drawn. However, the bar code printed on the previous label is cleared.

In the case of a customer code

1-module width

(6) Rotational angle of bar code

Point of origin

0° 90° 180° 270°

0° 90° 180° 270°

Point of origin

- 101 -

Page 106: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(7) Bar code height

Height

Height

[PDF417, MicroPDF417]

Height

Height

[Postal code]

Height

[RSS-14]

Height

[RSS-14 Stacked]

Height (The height of the bottom row is 7/5 of the specified height.)

[RSS-14 Stacked Omnidirectional]

Height (The height of the bottom row is the same as the specified height.)

- 102 -

Page 107: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[RSS-14 Limited]

Height

[RSS-14 Expanded]

Height

When the bar code height is set to 0000, a bar code (including guard bars) and numerals under bars are not drawn. However, the bar code printed on the previous label is cleared.

(8) Length of guard bar

The length of guard bar is valid only when the type of bar code is WPC. It is ignored in all other cases.

Length of guard bar

Height of bar code

(9) Numerals under bars

Numerals are/are not provided under bars according to the parameter for print/non print of numerals under bars. The numerals under bars to be printed vary according to the type of bar code. The font of numerals under bars is OCR-B. These numerals are enlarged or reduced only horizontally according to the width of the bar code. When they are drawn vertically, no enlargement or reduction is applied.

[Drawing positions of numerals under bars]

In the case of JAN and EAN (Example) EAN13 + 2 digits

(Example) EAN8

- 103 -

Page 108: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In the case of UPC (Example) UPC-A + 2 digits

(Example) UPC-E

In the case of bar codes other than JAN, EAN, and UPC (Example) CODE39

(Example) UCC/EAN128

(10) Start/Stop Code

This parameter is valid only when the type of bar code is CODE39 and NW7.

When the parameter is designated, whether or not the stop code and the start code are attached to the print data to be sent is not checked.

When the parameter is omitted in the case of CODE39 and NW7, a start/stop code will be attached. The code to be added is “*” in the case of CODE39, and “a” in the case of NW7.

For details, refer to chapter 15 “AUTOMATIC ADDITION OF START/STOP CODES”.

- 104 -

Page 109: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(11) Increment/decrement

Printing is performed while the data is incremented or decremented each time a label is issued. Where the data row exceeds the maximum number of digits (40), the data row will not be drawn.

When CODE128 (without auto code selection) is used, the number of the start code (code A, code B, and code C) digits is regarded as 2.

Initial value 0000 0000 0000 0000 999999 INC/DEC +10 +10 +10 +10 +1

Zero suppression Not designated 5 3 0 3

1st label 0000 0000 000 0000 999999 2nd label 0010 0010 010 0010 000 3rd label 0020 0020 020 0020 001 4th label 0030 0030 030 0030 002 5th label 0040 0040 040 0040 003

Letters and numerals for increment/decrement

For CODE39 (standard), CODE39 (full ASCII), NW-7, CODE93, CODE128, even if a data string other than numerals are included in the data, increment/decrement is performed. However, if any code which does not exist in each bar code table is contained in the data, increment/decrement is not performed.

Up to 40 digits (including letters, numerals, and symbols) are possible. Only the numerals are selected and calculated for incrementing/decrementing, and then are returned to the previous position to draw the data.

Example of increment/decrement calculation

Initial value 00000 A0A0A 7A8/9 A2A0A INC/DEC +1 +1 +3 -3 1st label 00000 A0A0A 7A8/9 A2A0A 2nd label 00001 A0A1A 7A9/2 A1A7A 3rd label 00002 A0A2A 7A9/5 A1A4A 4th label 00003 A0A3A 7A9/8 A1A1A 5th label 00004 A0A4A 8A0/1 A0A8A

Example of increment/decrement of data including the special codes of CODE128

Increment/decrement calculation starts from the lowest digit in the data strings. If the data string to be calculated is numeric and the next (upper) digit is “>”, this data is a special code (underlined digits shown in the table below). In such case, these two digits are skipped, and the next digit is calculated.

Example of increment/decrement calculation of CODE128

Initial value 00000 00>08 0A>08 0A9>08 INC/DEC +1 +1 +1 +1 1st label 00000 00>08 0A>08 0A9>08 2nd label 00001 00>09 0A>09 0A9>09 3rd label 00002 01>00 1A>00 1A0>00 4th label 00003 01>01 1A>01 1A0>01 5th label 00004 01>02 1A>02 1A0>02

- 105 -

Page 110: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(12) Zero suppression

No. of digits after zero suppression 0 1 2 2 3 4 5

Data 0000 0000 0000 0A12 0123 0123 0123Print 0000 0 00 A12 123 0123 0123

Zero(s) in a data row is replaced with a space(s) from the upper digits, according to the designated number of digits. However, if the number of digits after zero suppression is greater than the data row, the data row will be drawn without performing zero suppression. Where the data row exceeds the maximum number of digits (40), the data row will not be drawn.

When the print data including start/stop codes are sent, the start/stop codes are also counted as a digit each. When the bar code type is JAN, EAN, UPC, or UCC/EAN 128, the data will be drawn without performing zero suppression.

(13) Data string to be printed

Drawing data can be programmed by designating the number of digits after the symbol “=.” The maximum number of digits to be printed varies according to the types of bar codes. For codes, refer to chapter 13 “BAR CODE TABLE”.

(14) Link field No.

The link field No. can be programmed by designating it after the symbol “;.” After the link field No. is designated using the Format Command, the data string are linked by the Link Field Data Command to draw an image.

Up to 20 fields can be linked.

The following shows an example of linked fields on the two continuous labels.

[Format Command]

[ESC] PC01; ........................ ; 01 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 1 is designated. [ESC] PC02; ........................ ; 03 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 3 is designated. [ESC] PC03; ........................ ; 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 4 is designated. [ESC] XB01;................... ; 03, 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link fields No. 3 and No. 4 are

designated. [ESC] PC04; ........................ ; 02 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 2 is designated. [ESC] PC05; ........................ ; 03 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 3 is designated. [ESC] PC06; ........................ ; 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link field No. 4 is designated. [ESC] XB02;................... ; 03, 04 [LF] [NUL] : Link fields No. 3 and No. 4 are

designated. Designating the link field No.

- 106 -

Page 111: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Data Command]

[ESC] RB; A [LF] B [LF] ABCD [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] Link field No. 4 Link field No. 3 Link field No. 2 Link field No. 1

(15) Explanation for Data Matrix

ECC type

Data Matrix contains a function to correct a code reading error using an error correction code (ECC) and restore normal data. The ECC should be chosen from several types of ECCs according to usage. The general correction ability is as follows. However, it may vary according to the error conditions.

ECC type Error Correction Ability Overhead by ECC ECC0 0% ECC50 25% ECC80 33% ECC100 50% ECC140 75% ECC200 Approx. 30%

Low

High

A

ABCD 001 *ABCD001*

B

ABCD 001 *ABCD001*

Format ID

Data Matrix can handle all codes including alphanumerics, symbols and Kanji. Since data compression rate varies according to codes, a code to be used is designated using the format ID.

Format ID Code Details 1 Numerics 0 to 9 space 2 Letters A to Z space 3 Alphanumerics, symbols 0 to 9 A to Z space . , - / 4 Alphanumerics 0 to 9 A to Z space 5 ASCII (7 bit) 00H to 7FH 6 ISO (8 bit) 00H to FFH (Kanji)

- 107 -

Page 112: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Maximum number of digits

The maximum number of digits varies according to the ECC type or format ID. Since a Kanji character uses 2 bytes, its maximum number of digits becomes half of the following values.

ECC0 ECC50 ECC80 ECC100 ECC140 Format ID 1 500 457 402 300 144 Format ID 2 452 333 293 218 105 Format ID 3 394 291 256 190 91 Format ID 4 413 305 268 200 96 Format ID 5 310 228 201 150 72 Format ID 6 271 200 176 131 63

Numeric Alphanumeric 8 bit

ECC200 2000 2000 1556

For the maximum number of digits in cell units, see the next page.

Connection setting

The connection setting is used when the data cannot be expressed with a two-dimensional code. Data is comprised of more than one two-dimensional code. When three two-dimensional codes are used to comprise data, for example, identification information of 1/3, 2/3, and 3/3 is inserted into each two-dimensional code. The ID number is assigned to identify the proper combination of two-dimensional codes when plural connecting symbols are printed on one label. For example, when there are two kinds of data containing identification information for 1/2 and 2/2 in the same label, combination of two-dimensional codes is unclear. By adding the ID number, the combination is made clearer.

- 108 -

Page 113: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Cell size and the effective data capacity

ECC000 ECC050 ECC080 ECC100 ECC140 Symbol size

Numeric capacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Numeric capacity

Alphanumcapacity

8-bit byte

Numericcapacity

Alphanumcapacity

8-bit byte

Numericcapacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Numeric capacity

Alphanumcapacity

8-bit byte

Row Col capacity

capacity capacity capacity capacity

9 9 3 2 1 – – – – – – – – – – – – 11 11 12 8 5 1 1 – – – – – – – – – – 13 13 24 16 10 10 6 4 4 3 2 1 1 – – – – 15 15 37 25 16 20 13 9 13 9 6 8 5 3 – – – 17 17 53 35 23 32 21 14 24 16 10 16 11 7 2 1 1 19 19 72 48 31 46 30 20 36 24 16 25 17 11 6 4 3 21 21 92 61 40 61 41 27 50 33 22 36 24 15 12 8 5 23 23 115 76 50 78 52 34 65 43 28 47 31 20 17 11 7 25 25 140 93 61 97 65 42 82 54 36 60 40 26 24 16 1027 27 168 112 73 118 78 51 100 67 44 73 49 32 30 20 1329 29 197 131 86 140 93 61 120 80 52 88 59 38 38 25 1631 31 229 153 100 164 109 72 141 94 62 104 69 45 46 30 2033 33 264 176 115 190 126 83 164 109 72 121 81 53 54 36 2435 35 300 200 131 217 145 95 188 125 82 140 93 61 64 42 2837 37 339 226 148 246 164 108 214 143 94 159 106 69 73 49 3239 39 380 253 166 277 185 121 242 161 106 180 120 78 84 56 3641 41 424 282 185 310 206 135 270 180 118 201 134 88 94 63 4143 43 469 313 205 344 229 150 301 201 132 224 149 98 106 70 4645 45 500 345 226 380 253 166 333 222 146 248 165 108 118 78 5147 47 500 378 248 418 278 183 366 244 160 273 182 119 130 87 5749 49 500 413 271 457 305 200 402 268 176 300 200 131 144 96 63

- 109 -

Page 114: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

ECC200 Symbol size

Numeric capacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Row Col capacity

10 10 6 3 1 12 12 10 6 3 14 14 16 10 6 16 16 24 16 1018 18 36 25 1620 20 44 31 2022 22 60 43 2824 24 72 52 3426 26 88 64 4232 32 124 91 6036 36 172 127 8440 40 228 169 112 44 44 288 214 142 48 48 348 259 172 52 52 408 304 202 64 64 560 418 278 72 72 736 550 366 80 80 912 682 454 88 88 1152 862 574 96 96 1392 1042 694 104 104 1632 1222 814 120 120 2000 1573 1048 132 132 2000 1954 1302 144 144 2000 2000 1556

Rectangular code

ECC200 Symbol size

Numeric capacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Row Col capacity

8 18 10 6 3 8 32 20 13 8

12 26 32 22 1412 36 44 31 2016 36 64 46 3016 48 98 72 47

- 110 -

Page 115: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(16) Explanation for the PDF417 and MicroPDF417

Security level

The PDF417 contains a function to correct a code reading error using an error correcting code word and restore normal data. The security level should be designated according to usage.

For the MicroPDF417, the printer sets the security level automatically.

Security level Error Correction Ability No. of error correction code words

Level 0 0 Level 1 2 Level 2 6 Level 3 14 Level 4 30 Level 5 62 Level 6 126 Level 7 254 Level 8 510

No. of columns (strings)

The number of rows and the row length (No. of data strings) are variable in the PDF417. Therefore, the form of the symbol can be changed in the proportion of the height and width in accordance with the paper to be used.

The number of columns (the number of data strings) is varied between 1 and 30. If the number of columns is set to too small though the data volume is large and the

security level is high, drawing may not be performed. This is because the number of rows may exceed 90 when the number of columns is too small. (When the PDF417 is used, the number of rows of symbols is limited in a range from 3 to 90.)

For the MicroPDF417, not only the number of columns (data strings) but also the number of rows (data lines) can be designated. When these are to be designated, see the table. Note that the max. number of digits for the set parameter (gg) varies according to the character type. If data over the max. number of digits for the set parameter (gg) is set, a bar code is not printed. The number of columns (data strings) is varied in a range from 1 to 4.

Though the max. number of lines is 44, it depends on the number of columns.

(17) Explanation for QR code

Error correction level

The QR code contains functions to detect and correct an error. If one of the data characters is damaged, the data can be restored when this code is read.

There are 4 levels of error correction. The level should be specified according to usage. The general correction ability is as follows.

Level Error correction ability Overhead by correcting an error

High density level Low 7%

Standard level 15%

Reliability level 25%

High reliability level High 30%

Low

High

- 111 -

Page 116: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

1-cell width 1-cell width

1-cell width

When the 1-cell width is set to 0, a two-dimensional code is not drawn. However, the bar code printed on the previous label is cleared.

Selection of mode

All codes including alphanumerics, symbols, and Kanji can be used in one QR code. Manual mode or automatic mode can be selected to perform the operation.

Selection of model

Model 1: Original specification Model 2: Extended specification which enhances the function of position correction

and can contain a large amount of data.

Mask number

It is preferable that the black and white modules are arranged in well-balanced manner so that a QR code is read for sure. The mask number prevents the bit pattern “1011101”, which is characteristically seen in the position detecting pattern, from appearing in the symbol as much as possible.

The mask number is ranging from 0 to 7. The pattern of the code is determined by placing each masking pattern for the mask number over the module pattern. When the mask number is set to 8, masking is not performed. When the parameter is omitted, the most appropriate mask number is automatically selected to perform masking.

Connection setting

For QR code, data can be divided into several codes. Even though the print space is limited, divided codes can be printed there. The data can be divided into a max. of 16 codes. Parity data is obtained by XORing all input data in units of bytes before dividing. The input data is calculated based on shift JIS for Kanji, or on JIS 8 for others. Examples are shown below:

“0123456789 ” is divided into “0123”, “4567”, and “89 ”.

Code No. 1 No. of divided codes: 3 Parity data: 85 Data “0123” Code No. 2 No. of divided codes: 3 Parity data: 85 Data “4567” Code No. 3 No. of divided codes: 3 Parity data: 85 Data “89 ”

* The parity data is the XORed value for “0123456789 ”. 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 93 FA 96 7B = 85

- 112 -

Page 117: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(18) Explanation for MaxiCode

Connection setting

For MaxiCode, data can be divided into a max. of 8 codes.

(19) Explanation for CP code

ECC (Error Correction Code) level

The CP code contains a function to correct a code reading error using an error correcting code word and restore normal data. The error correction level should be selected according to usage.

The higher the percentage of the error correcting code word is, the higher the error correcting ability is.

For the CP code, the program is designed so that all remaining areas are used for correcting errors when the number of code characters is specified by a user. When the number of code characters is specified, “0” (No designation) can be used.

When the number of code characters is not specified by a user, a value must be selected from a range of 10 to 50%. The printer automatically determines the number of code characters so that the error correcting code word exceeds the percentage specified by user.

The number of bits per character

Data is compressed by using the 8-bit compression method. Even if “0” is specified, the data will be compressed in the same way.

Character set for 8 bits

8 bits: ISO 00H to FFH (for Kanji)

The number of code characters

For the CP code, a 3×3-cell is used for one block, and a CP code consists of these blocks.

The numbers of characters in the X and Y directions can be set by a user. If “0” is specified, the printer automatically sets the smallest code size that can contain

the data set by the user. The rectangular code can be also specified. In that case, the value for the Y

direction must be smaller than the X direction. The number of cells per code is as follows. (No. of code characters) × 3 + 2

- 113 -

Page 118: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(20) Explanation for RFID

The number of bytes to be written

.The number of bytes to be written on the tag depends on the type of tag.

Sequence of writing data on the RFID tag

Data is written on the RFID tag prior to printing. When +3-mm or more feed, or a –3-mm or less feed has been set in the @003 command, the printer performs a forward/reverse feed before printing, according to the command setting. When writing data onto the RFID tag succeeds, the printer feeds the paper in the direction opposite to the feed performed before data write, and then starts printing. If writing data fails, and when the parameter of RFID adjustment for retry has been set to +3mm or more, or –3mm or less in the system mode, the printer performs a forward/reverse feed again and retries to write data. If writing data failed after all, the printer prints the void pattern on that paper to abandon it, and retries the next tag up to the maximum number of RFID issue retries.

Notes

(1) The check digit attachment, increment/decrement, and zero suppression are performed according to the following priority. If any of the conditions is improper, no drawing will take place.

For example, the zero(s) is replaced with a space(s) as a result of zero suppression, but the modulus 10 designated to be attached cannot be calculated.

Increment/decrement > zero suppression > attachment of check digit

(2) Up to 32 fields for which incrementing/decrementing has been designated can be drawn. If the total bit map font, outline font, and bar code increment/decrement fields exceeds 32, drawing will take place without incrementing/decrementing any excessive field. The field to be incremented or decremented is incremented or decremented until the Image Buffer Clear Command ([ESC] C) is transmitted.

- 114 -

Page 119: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[Example]

Format Command (Increment bar code No. 01 (+1)) Format Command (Increment bar code No. 02 (+2)) Image Buffer Clear Command Data Command (Bar code No. 01 “0001”) Data Command (Bar code No. 02 “0100”) Issue Command (2 labels)

(0100)

(0001)

(0102)

(0002)

Issue Command (1 label)

(0104)

(0003)

Image Buffer Clear Command Data Command (Bar code No. 02 “3000”) Issue Command (1 label)

(3000)

(3) More than one Bar Code Format Command can be connected when transmitted.

[ESC] XB01; 0100, 0150, 3, 1, 02, 02, 06, 06, 02, 0, 0150 [LF] B02; 0350, 0150, 3, 1, 02, 02, 06, 06, 02, 0, 0150 [LF] [NUL]

(4) When the drawing data differs for every label, the field of the drawing data for the previous label is automatically cleared using the bar code number, then the next drawing data is printed. Therefore, the bar code number should be designated so that they differ according to the drawing fields. Since the automatic field clear is not performed between the Clear Command ([ESC] C) and Issue Command ([ESC] XS), the fixed data may be drawn using the same bar code number. In this case, the Format Command and Data Command should be sent alternately. (After the Issue Command is sent, the fields with the same bar code number are automatically cleared until the Clear Command is sent.)

- 115 -

Page 120: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(5) The link field designation is cleared by omitting the link field designation using the same bar code No. and reformatting data.

The link field designation can also be cleared by the Image Buffer Clear Command.

(6) A print data string and the link field No. cannot be programmed at the same time.

Refer to Bit Map Font Format Command ([ESC] PC) Outline Font Format Command ([ESC] PV) Bar Code Data Command ([ESC] RB)

Examples

12.5mm

55.0mm

Origin (0, 0)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0125, 3, 1, 03, 03, 08, 08, 03, 0, 0150=12345 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB02; 0830, 0550, 3, 1, 02, 04, 07, 08, 04, 3, 0150, +0000000000, 1, 00, N [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB02; *ABC* [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

20.0 mm

83.0 mm

Effective print area

15.0mm

(1)

15.0 mm

- 116 -

Page 121: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Effective print area

30.0mm

55.0mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Origin (0, 0) (2)

S 0 0 1

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, C, 00, B; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B; 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0550, 3, 1, 03, 03, 08, 08, 03, 0, 0150; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB; S [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 117 -

Page 122: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Effective print area

20.0 mm

Origin (0, 0) (3)

12.5mm

55.0mm

83.0 mm

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0125, P, 04, 02, 03, 0, 0010 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB02; 0830, 0550, Q, 08, 03, 05, 3 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB01; PDF417 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB02; Data Matrix [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 118 -

Page 123: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.11 BIT MAP FONT DATA COMMAND [ESC] RC

Function Provides data for the bit map font row.

Format [ESC] RCaaa; bbb ------ bbb [LF] [NUL]

Link Field Data Command [ESC] RC; ccc ------ ccc [LF] ddd ------ ddd [LF] ------ [LF] xxx ------ xxx [LF] [NUL]

Term aaa: Character string number 000 to 199 (Two digits, 00 to 99, also acceptable.)

bbb ------ bbb: Data string to be printed Max. 255 digits (Max. 127 digits when the font type is e, j, v, or w.) Any excess data will be discarded. For the character codes, refer to chapter 12 “CHARACTER CODE TABLE”.

ccc ------ ccc: Data string of link field No. 1

ddd ------ ddd: Data string of link field No. 2

to

xxx ------ xxx: Data string of link field No. 99

Explanation (1) Link field data string

• After the link field No. is designated in the Format Command, data strings are linked using the Link Field Data Command to draw an image.

• Up to 255 digits of data strings can be linked. However, when the font type is e, j, v, or w, only up to 127 digits can be linked. When the number of digits exceeds the maximum value, excess data will be discarded.

• Up to 99 data strings can be linked.

• Up to 2048 bytes can be used as the command length ([ESC] to [NUL]) of the Link Field Data Command.

• When the data string is omitted in the Link Field Data Command, the following process is performed:

No process will be performed for the field which contains no print data due to the omission.

When the field partially loses print data due to the omission, the only remaining data will be processed as print data.

• The Link Field Data Command can be used for the bit map font fields, outline font fields, and bar code fields. (The same result is obtained when any of the “RC,” “RV” or “RB” command code is designated.)

Refer to Bit Map Font Format Command ([ESC] PC)

- 119 -

Page 124: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

55.0 mm

12.5 mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Origin (0, 0)

Effective print area

Sample

(1)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0125, 1, 1, C, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC002; 0650, 0550, 2, 2, G, 33, B, +0000000001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC002; 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 120 -

Page 125: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Effective print area

(2)

30.0 mm

55.0 mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Origin (0, 0)

S 0 0 1

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, C, 00, B; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B; 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0550, 3, 1, 03, 03, 08, 08, 03, 0, 0150; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC; S [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 121 -

Page 126: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

12.5mm

30.0mm

20.0 mm

Effective print area

Origin (0, 0) (3)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC000; 0200, 0125, 1, 1, X, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, X, 01, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC000; AB [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; AB [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 122 -

Page 127: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.12 OUTLINE FONT DATA COMMAND [ESC] RV

Function Provides data for the outline font row.

Format [ESC] RVaa; bbb ------ bbb [LF] [NUL]

Link Field Data Command [ESC] RV; ccc ------ ccc [LF] ddd ------ ddd [LF] ------ [LF] xxx ------ xxx [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Character string number 00 to 99

bbb ------ bbb: Data string to be printed Max. 255 digits Any excess data will be discarded. For the character codes, refer to chapter 12 “CHARACTER CODE TABLE”.

ccc ------ ccc: Data string of link field No. 1

ddd ------ ddd: Data string of link field No. 2

to

xxx ------ xxx: Data string of link field No. 99

Explanation (1) Link field data string

• After the link field No. is designated in the Format Command, data strings are linked using the Link Field Data Command to draw an image.

• Up to 255 digits of data strings can be linked. Data exceeding the max. number of digits will be discarded.

• Up to 99 data strings can be linked.

• Up to 2048 bytes can be used as the command length ([ESC] to [NUL]) of the Link Field Data Command.

• When the data string is omitted in the Link Field Data Command, the following process is performed:

No process will be performed for the field which contains no print data due to the omission.

When the field partially loses print data due to the omission, the only remaining data will be processed as print data.

• The Link Field Data Command can be used for the bit map font fields, outline font fields, and bar code fields. (The same result is obtained when any of the “RC,” “RV” or “RB” command code is designated.)

Refer to Outline Font Format Command ([ESC] PV)

- 123 -

Page 128: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

55.0 mm

12.5 mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Origin (0, 0)

Effective print area

Sample

(1)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0200, 0125, 0100, 0100, B, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV02; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B, +0000000001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RV01; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RV02; 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 124 -

Page 129: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

30.0 mm

55.0 mm

20.0 mm

65.0 mm

Effective print area

Origin (0, 0) (2)

S 0 0 1

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, C, 00, B; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B; 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0550, 3, 1, 02, 02, 06, 06, 02, 0, 0150; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC; S [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 125 -

Page 130: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.13 BAR CODE DATA COMMAND [ESC] RB

Function Provides data for the bar code.

Format [ESC] RBaa; bbb ------ bbb [LF] [NUL]

Link Field Data Command [ESC] RB; ccc ------ ccc [LF] ddd ------ ddd [LF] ------ [LF] xxx ------ xxx [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Bar code number 00 to 31

bbb ------ bbb: Data string to be printed The maximum number of digits varies according to the type of bar code.

ccc ------ ccc: Data string of link field No. 1

ddd ------ ddd: Data string of link field No. 2

to

xxx ------ xxx: Data string of link field No. 99

The Data Command for the MaxiCode is described later.

Explanation (1) Data check

If the data row contains data which does not meet the type of bar code, a bar code will not be drawn. If wrong code selection takes place in the data row of CODE128 (without auto code selection), the bar code will not be drawn.

In case of Data Matrix, if there is data different from the one designated using the format ID, a symbol is not drawn.

(2) No. of digits of data

When data exceeding the maximum number of digits is sent, the excess data will be discarded. For the maximum number of digits for each bar code, see below.

Data Matrix, PDF417, QR code: 2000 digits CP code: 473 digits MicroPDF417: 366 digits MaxiCode: 93 digits Customer bar code: 20 digits Highest priority customer bar code: 19 digits POSTNET: 5, 9, 11 digits ROYAL MAIL 4 STATE CUSTOMER CODE: 12 digits KIX CODE: 18 digits Bar codes other than the above 126 digits

When the number of digits does not correspond to the bar code type, the bar code is not drawn.

For the MaxiCode, the maximum number of digits varies according to the mode. In mode 2 or mode 3, the maximum number of digits is 84. In mode 4 or mode 6, the maximum number of digits is 93, respectively.

- 126 -

Page 131: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

The maximum number of digits for Data Matrix varies according to the settings for ECC type, format ID, and the cell size. In the case of Kanji, the maximum number of digits becomes half of the values described below since a Kanji character occupies 2 bytes.

Maximum number of digits for Data Matrix

ECC0 ECC50 ECC80 ECC100 ECC140 Format ID 1 500 457 402 300 144 Format ID 2 452 333 293 218 105 Format ID 3 394 291 256 190 91 Format ID 4 413 305 268 200 96 Format ID 5 310 228 201 150 72 Format ID 6 271 200 176 131 63

Numeric Alphanumeric 8 bit

ECC200 2000 2000 1556

The maximum writable data volume on the RFID is 512 bytes. However, the actually writable data volume varies according to the type of tag to be used.

Cell Size and Effective Data Capacity

ECC000 ECC050 ECC080 ECC100 ECC140 Symbol size

Numeric capacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Numeric capacity

Alphanumcapacity

8-bit byte

Numericcapacity

Alphanumcapacity

8-bit byte

Numericcapacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Numeric capacity

Alphanumcapacity

8-bit byte

Row Col capacity

capacity capacity capacity capacity

9 9 3 2 1 – – – – – – – – – – – – 11 11 12 8 5 1 1 – – – – – – – – – – 13 13 24 16 10 10 6 4 4 3 2 1 1 – – – – 15 15 37 25 16 20 13 9 13 9 6 8 5 3 – – – 17 17 53 35 23 32 21 14 24 16 10 16 11 7 2 1 1 19 19 72 48 31 46 30 20 36 24 16 25 17 11 6 4 3 21 21 92 61 40 61 41 27 50 33 22 36 24 15 12 8 5 23 23 115 76 50 78 52 34 65 43 28 47 31 20 17 11 7 25 25 140 93 61 97 65 42 82 54 36 60 40 26 24 16 1027 27 168 112 73 118 78 51 100 67 44 73 49 32 30 20 1329 29 197 131 86 140 93 61 120 80 52 88 59 38 38 25 1631 31 229 153 100 164 109 72 141 94 62 104 69 45 46 30 2033 33 264 176 115 190 126 83 164 109 72 121 81 53 54 36 2435 35 300 200 131 217 145 95 188 125 82 140 93 61 64 42 2837 37 339 226 148 246 164 108 214 143 94 159 106 69 73 49 3239 39 380 253 166 277 185 121 242 161 106 180 120 78 84 56 3641 41 424 282 185 310 206 135 270 180 118 201 134 88 94 63 4143 43 469 313 205 344 229 150 301 201 132 224 149 98 106 70 4645 45 500 345 226 380 253 166 333 222 146 248 165 108 118 78 5147 47 500 378 248 418 278 183 366 244 160 273 182 119 130 87 5749 49 500 413 271 457 305 200 402 268 176 300 200 131 144 96 63

- 127 -

Page 132: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

ECC200 Symbol size

Numeric capacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Row Col capacity

10 10 6 3 1 12 12 10 6 3 14 14 16 10 6 16 16 24 16 1018 18 36 25 1620 20 44 31 2022 22 60 43 2824 24 72 52 3426 26 88 64 4232 32 124 91 6036 36 172 127 8440 40 228 169 112 44 44 288 214 142 48 48 348 259 172 52 52 408 304 202 64 64 560 418 278 72 72 736 550 366 80 80 912 682 454 88 88 1152 862 574 96 96 1392 1042 694 104 104 1632 1222 814 120 120 2000 1573 1048 132 132 2000 1954 1302 144 144 2000 2000 1556

Rectangular code

ECC200 Symbol size

Numeric capacity

Alphanum capacity

8-bit byte

Row Col capacity

8 18 10 6 3 8 32 20 13 8

12 26 32 22 1412 36 44 31 2016 36 64 46 3016 48 98 72 47

- 128 -

Page 133: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

When PDF417 or MicroPDF417 is used, the number of symbol characters, called code words, is limited to 928 or less. Moreover, the data compression rate varies according to the data. Therefore, the maximum number of digits according to modes is as follows.

When letters and numerics are mixed in data in EXC mode, for example, the maximum values become smaller than the values below, since the internal mode selection code is used.

To correct a reading error by designating the security level, the maximum value becomes further smaller, since the error correction code words below are used.

When the number of the code words exceeds 928, or when the number of rows exceeds 90, a symbol is not drawn.

For the MicroPDF417, the numbers of rows and columns can be specified. The maximum number of digits varies according to the setting.

In the case of PDF417

• Extended Alphanumeric Compaction (EXC) mode: 1850 digits • Binary/ASCII Plus mode: 1108 digits • Numeric compaction mode: 2000 digits

In the case of MicroPDF417

• Binary mode: 150 digits • Upper case letter/space mode: 250 digits • Numeric compaction mode: 366 digits

No. of Error Correction Code Words of PDF417 For the MicroPDF417, the printer sets the security level automatically.

Security level Error Correction Ability No. of error correction code words

Level 0 0 Level 1 2 Level 2 6 Level 3 14 Level 4 30 Level 5 62 Level 6 126 Level 7 254 Level 8 510

Low

High

- 129 -

Page 134: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

The maximum number of columns and rows for the MicroPDF417

Parameter (gg) No. of columns No. of rows Max. number of digits

for binary mode Max. number of digits for

upper case letter/space mode Max. number of digits

for numeric mode

00 – – 150 250 366 01 1 – 22 38 55 02 2 – 43 72 105 03 3 – 97 162 237 04 4 – 150 250 366 05 11 3 6 8 06 14 7 12 17 07 1 17 10 18 26 08 20 13 22 32 09 24 18 30 44 10 28 22 38 55 11 8 8 14 20 12 11 14 24 35 13 14 21 36 52 14 2 17 27 46 67 15 20 33 56 82 16 23 38 64 93 17 26 43 72 105 18 6 6 10 14 19 8 10 18 26 20 10 15 26 38 21 12 20 34 49 22 3 15 27 46 67 23 20 39 66 96 24 26 54 90 132 25 32 68 114 167 26 38 82 138 202 27 44 97 162 237 28 4 8 14 20 29 6 13 22 32 30 8 20 34 49 31 10 27 46 67 32 12 34 58 85 33 4 15 45 76 111 34 20 63 106 155 35 26 85 142 208 36 32 106 178 261 37 38 128 214 313 38 44 150 250 366

- 130 -

Page 135: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3) CODE128 code selection

In the case of CODE128 (with auto code selection), code selection is performed in the following manner. (Conforming to USS-128 APPENDIX-G)

Determining the start character

(a) If the data begins with four or more consecutive numerals, the start code to be used is (CODE C).

(b) In any case other than (a) in , if a control character appears before a small letter (see .) or four or more consecutive numerals, the start code is (CODE A).

(c) In none of the above cases, the start code is (CODE B).

If the data begins with an odd number of digits in (a), :

(a) Insert the (CODE A) or (CODE B) character just before the last numeric data. When (FNC1), if found in the number, breaks a pair of digits in the number, insert the (CODE A) or (CODE B) character before the numeric data preceding the (FNC1). Selection of (CODE A) or (CODE B) should conform to (b) and (c) in .

If four or more digits of numeric data continue in (CODE A) or (CODE B).

(a) When the numeric data is an even number of digits, insert the (CODE C) character just before the first numeric data.

(b) When the numeric data is an odd number of digits, insert the (CODE C) character immediately after the first numeric data.

If a control character appears in (CODE B):

(a) In the subsequent data, when a small letter appears before the next control character or four or more consecutive digits, insert the (SHIFT) character before the first control character.

(b) When not so, insert the (CODE B) character just before the first control character.

If a small letter appears in (CODE A):

(a) In the subsequent data, when a control character appears before the next small letter or four or more consecutive digits, insert the (SHIFT) character before the first small letter.

(b) When not so, insert the (CODE B) character just before the first small letter.

If any data other than the numerals appears in (CODE C):

(a) Insert the (CODE A) or (CODE B) character just before the data other than the numerals. Selection of (CODE A) or (CODE B) should conform to (b) and (c) in .

- 131 -

Page 136: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(4) CODE128 code selection check

Check if selection of (CODE A), (CODE B), or (CODE C) of CODE128 has been set correctly. If an error is found, the bar code will not be drawn.

[Conditions causing an error]

No start code is designated.

A small letter (including { , | , } , ~, _ ) is found in (CODE A).

A control character is found in (CODE B).

Any data other than the numerals, (FNC1), (CODE A), and (CODE B) is found in (CODE C).

There are two or more consecutive (SHIFT) characters.

The number in (CODE C) is an odd number of digits.

(SHIFT) is followed by (CODE A), (CODE B) or (CODE C).

(5) Kanji code selection

• In the case of Data Matrix, PDF417, and QR code, Kanji codes can be printed. Shift JIS, JIS hexadecimal, JIS 8, or the mixture of these codes can be used.

(6) Link field data string • After the link field No. is designated in the Format Command, data strings are

linked using the Link Field Data Command to draw an image. • Up to 2000 digits of data strings of Data Matrix or PDF417 can be linked. For

other bar code types, up to 126 digits can be linked. (The value varies according to the type of bar code.) When the number of digits exceeds the maximum value, excess data will be discarded.

• Up to 99 data strings can be linked. • Up to 2048 bytes can be used as the command length ([ESC] to [NUL]) of the

Link Field Data Command. • When the data string is omitted in the Link Field Data Command, the following

process is performed: No process will be performed for the field which contains no print data due to

the omission. When the field partially loses print data due to the omission, the only

remaining data will be processed as print data. • The Link Field Data Command can be used for the bit map font fields, outline

font fields, and bar code fields. (The same result is obtained when any of the “RC,” “RV”, or “RB” command code is designated.)

- 132 -

Page 137: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(7) When manual mode is selected in the Format Command for a QR code

Numeric mode, alphanumeric and symbol mode, Kanji mode

Mode selection Data to be printed

Binary mode

Mode selection No. of data strings (4 digits)

Data to be printed

Mixed mode

Data “,” (comma) Data “,” (comma) Data

The QR code can contain all codes including alphanumerics, symbols and Kanji.

Since data compression rate varies according to codes, the code to be used is designated when the mode is selected.

Mode Code Details N Numerals 0 to 9 A Alphanumerics, symbols A to Z 0 to 9 space

$ % * + - . / : B Binary (8-bit) 00H to FFH K Kanji Shift JIS, JIS hexadecimal

If mixed mode is selected, up to 200 modes can be selected in a QR code.

(8) When the automatic mode is selected in the Format Command for a QR code.

Data to be printed

(9) How to transmit the control code data

NUL (00H) = > @ (3EH, 40H) SOH (01H) = > A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) = > B (3EH, 42H) GS (1DH) = > ] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) = > ^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) = > _ (3EH, 5FH)

* How to transmit the special codes

> (3EH) = > 0 (3EH, 30H)

- 133 -

Page 138: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(10) Transfer code for QR code

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS - = M ] m } E SO RS • > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o DEL

* The shaded parts are Japanese. They are omitted here.

(11) Examples of data designation

Alphanumeric mode: ABC123

A A B C 1 2 3

Data to be printed Designation of mode

Binary mode: 01H, 03H, 05H

B 0 0 0 6 > A > C > E

Data to be printed No. of data strings Designation of mode

Mixed mode

Numeric mode : 123456 Kanji mode : Kanji data Binary mode : a i u e o Alphanumeric mode : ABC

N 1 2 3 4 5 6, K Kanji data, B 0 0 1 0 a i u e o , A A B C

Data to be printed

Data to be printed No. of data strings

Data to be printed printed

Designation of mode

Automatic mode

When the data above ( ) is designated in automatic mode:

1 2 3 4 5 6 Kanji data a i u e o A B C

Data to be

Data to be printed

- 134 -

Page 139: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(12) MaxiCode data

For mode 2 or 3: [ESC] RBaa; bbbbbbbbbcccdddeeeee --- eeeee [LF] [NUL]

For mode 4 or 6: [ESC] RBaa; fffffffffggggg --- ggggg [LF] [NUL]

bbbbbbbbb: Postal code Fixed as 9 digits • Mode 2:

b1b2b3b4b5: Zip code Fixed as 5 digits (Numerics) b6b7b8b9: Zip code extension Fixed as 4 digits (Numerics)

• Mode 3: b1b2b3b4b5b6: Zip code Fixed as 6 digits (Character of code

set A)

b7b8b9: Vacant Fixed as 3 digits (20H)

ccc: Class of service Fixed as 3 digits (Numerics)

ddd: Country code Fixed as 3 digits (Numerics)

eee --- eee: Message data strings 84 digits

fffffffff: Primary message data strings 9 digits

ggg --- ggg: Secondary message data strings 84 digits

NOTES: 1. When any data other than numerics is included in the data string of zip code (mode 2), zip code extension, class of service, or country code, a MaxiCode is not drawn.

2. If the message data is less than 84 digits when mode 2 or 3 is selected, the printer adds one digit of CR (000000) at the end of the data, and the remaining digits will be filled with FSs (011100). When message data exceeding 84 digits is received, the excess data will be discarded before drawing a MaxiCode.

3. If the message data is less than 93 digits (9 digits + 84 digits) when mode 4 or 6 is selected, the printer adds one digit of CR (000000) at the end of the data, and the remaining digits will be filled with FSs (011100). When message data exceeding 93 digits is received, the excess data will be discarded before drawing a MaxiCode.

4. Mode 6 should not be used for usual operation since it is used for scanner programming.

5. When “TYPE2: Special specification” is set for MaxiCode specification setting in the system mode and when Mode 2 is selected, the country code must be 840. Otherwise, a MaxiCode will not be drawn.

6. When “TYPE2: Special specification” is set for MaxiCode specification setting in the system mode and when Mode 3 is selected, the country code must be other than 840. Otherwise, a MaxiCode will not be drawn.

- 135 -

Page 140: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

20.0 mm

15.0 mm

55.0 mm

12.5 mm

83.0 mm

15.0 mm

(1) Origin (0, 0)

Effective print area

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0125, 3, 1, 02, 02, 06, 06, 02, 0, 0150 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB02; 0830, 0550, 3, 1, 02, 04, 07, 08, 04, 3, 0150, +0000000000, 1, 00, N [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB01; 12345 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB02; *ABC* [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

- 136 -

Page 141: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(2)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0300, 1, 1, C, 00, B; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PV01; 0650, 0550, 0200, 0150, B, 33, B; 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0550, 3, 1, 02, 02, 06, 06, 02, 0, 0150; 01, 02 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB; S [LF] 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

Effective print area30.0mm

55.0mm

Origin (0, 0)

20.0 mm

S 0 0 1

65.0 mm

- 137 -

Page 142: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3)

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0125, P, 04, 02, 03, 0, 0010 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB02; 0830, 0550, Q, 08, 03, 05, 3 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB01; PDF417 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB02; Data Matrix [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C4000 [LF] [NUL]

Effective print area

Origin (0, 0)

12.5mm

55.0mm

20.0 mm

83.0 mm

- 138 -

Page 143: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.14 ISSUE COMMAND [ESC] XS

Function Issues labels according to the print conditions programmed.

Format [ESC] XS; I, aaaa, bbbcdefgh [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: Number of labels to be issued 0001 to 9999

bbb: Cut interval. Designates the number of pieces to be printed before a cut operation is performed.

000 to 100 (000 when no cut)

c: Type of sensor 0: No sensor 1: Reflective sensor 2: Transmissive sensor 3: Transmissive sensor (when using manual threshold value) 4: Reflective sensor (when using manual threshold value)

d: Issue mode C: Batch mode D: Strip mode (with reverse feed, the strip sensor is activated.)

E: Strip mode (with reverse feed, the strip sensor is ignored, supporting an applicator.)

e: Print speed 2: 2 ips 4: 4 ips 6: 6 ips

f: Use of ribbon 0: No ribbon 1: Ribbon is used. 2: Ribbon is used.

g: Print orientation and mirror printing 0: Bottom first printing 1: Top first printing 2: Bottom first mirror printing 3: Top first mirror printing

h: Type of status response 0: No status response 1: Status response is returned.

- 139 -

Page 144: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Explanation (1) Number of labels to be issued

If increment/decrement is not specified, the same data will be printed on the designated number of labels.

If increment/decrement is specified, the designated number of labels will be printed while incrementing/decrementing the designated drawing area one by one.

* The increment/decrement designation is valid until the Image Buffer Clear Command ([ESC] C) is transmitted.

(2) Cut interval

The cut interval is valid only when the cutter has been installed and the issue mode is set to “C”. If an error occurs during an issue after the cut interval is designated, and then printing is restarted, the printer ejects the printed paper, then resumes printing from the paper on which the error occurred.

When the automatic forward feed standby function is enabled in the system mode, the printer automatically performs an approximately 14.0-mm forward feed if no subsequent command is sent from the PC in 1 second after issuing the last label. However, if the label pitch length is 20 mm or less, the edge of the label is caught on the head, when the label is fed backward to the home position. Therefore, even if the automatic forward feed standby is specified, a forward feed is not performed.

When receiving the Issue Command during the automatic forward feed standby, the printer starts issuing the label after feeding it backward to the print start position.

If any command is sent and processed after the Issue Command is sent, the automatic forward feed is not performed. Therefore, a command should not be sent after the Issue Command is sent. Before the automatic forward feed is performed, the printer should not be turned off then on, or placed in a pause state and reset. Doing so and pressing the [FEED] key prevents the automatic forward feed from being performed.

If the paper is fed by pressing the [FEED] key of the printer during the forward feed standby, the printer feeds one label, cuts, performs the automatic forward feed, and then stops.

(3) Type of sensor No sensor: Printing takes place according to the parameter designated by the

Label Size Set Command.

Reflective sensor: Printing takes place according to the parameter designated by the Label Size

Set Command. However, the black mark provided on the back side of the tag paper is automatically detected by the reflective sensor and the paper position is finely adjusted for every piece.

Transmissive sensor: Printing takes place according to the parameter designated by the Label Size

Set Command. However, the label-to-label gap is automatically detected by the transmissive sensor and the paper position is finely adjusted for every piece.

- 140 -

Page 145: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Transmissive sensor (when using manual threshold value): Printing takes place according to the parameter designated by the Label Size

Set Command. However, the label-to-label gap is automatically detected by the transmissive sensor and the paper position is finely adjusted for every piece according to the value set by the threshold setting operation (key operation).

Reflective sensor (when using manual threshold value)

Printing takes place according to the parameters designated by the Label Size Set Command. However, the black mark provided on the back of the tag paper is automatically detected by the reflective sensor and the paper position is finely adjusted for every piece, according to the value set by the threshold setting operation (key operation).

(4) Issue mode

[C: Batch mode (Cut interval: 0, Issue count: 3)]

• “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to OFF in the system mode.

Print head position

A

A B

A B C

(1) Idling (at the print start position)

(2) Prints the 1st label (A).

(3) Prints the 2nd label (B).

(4) Prints the 3rd label (C).

[C: Batch mode (Cut interval: 0, Issue count: 3)]

• “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to ON in the system mode.

Print head position

A

A B

(1) Idling (during the forward feed standby)

A B

(3) Prints the 1st label (A).

C

(4) Prints the 2nd label (B).

(5) Prints the 3rd label (C).

A B C (6) After 1 second, performs 14.0-mm automatic forward feed.

(2) Reverse feed to the print start position.

- 141 -

Page 146: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[C: Batch mode (Cut interval: 1, Issue count: 2)]

• “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to OFF in the system mode.

• When the cutter is used:

(1) Idling

A

A

A

B

Print head positionCut position

(2) Completes printing the 1st label (A).

(3) Feeds the 1st label (A) to the cut position.

(4) Cuts the 1st label (A).

(6) Completes printing the 2nd label (B).

(7) Feeds the 2nd label (B) to the cut position.

(8) Cuts the 2nd label (B).

B

B

(9) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(5) Reverse feed to the print start position.

- 142 -

Page 147: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[C: Batch mode (Cut interval: 1, Issue count: 2)]

• “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to ON in the system mode.

• When the cutter is used:

(1) Idling (during the forward feed standby)

A

A

A

B

Print head positionCut position

(3) Completes printing the 1st label (A).

(4) Feeds the 1st label (A) to the cut position.

(5) Cuts the 1st label (A).

(7) Completes printing the 2nd label (B).

(8) Feeds the 2nd label (B) to the cut position.

(9) Cuts the 2nd label (B).

B

B

(10) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(6) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(2) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(11) After 1 second, performs 14.0-mm automatic forward feed.

- 143 -

Page 148: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[D: Strip mode (Issue count: 3)]

A

B

C

Print head positionStrip position

(1) Idling

(3) Completes printing the 1st label (A).

(4) Remove the 1st label (A).

(6) Completes printing the 2nd label (B).

(7) Remove the 2nd label (B).

(9) Completes printing the 3rd label (C)

* The next label is not printed until the 3rd label (C) is removed.

(2) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(5) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(8) Reverse feed to the print start position.

- 144 -

Page 149: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[E: Strip mode (Issue mode: E)]

The expansion I/O is installed:

The strip sensor is ignored. An issue is performed by checking a PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O.

A

B

C

Print head positionStrip position

(1) Idling The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned

ON.

(3) Completes printing the 1st label (A). The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned

ON.

(4) Remove the 1st label (A). The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned

OFF.

(6) Completes printing the 2nd label (B). The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned

ON.

(7) Remove the 2nd label (B). The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned

OFF.

(9) Completes printing the 3rd label (C). The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned

ON.

* While the PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is on, a label is not printed.

(2) The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned OFF.

Reverse feed to the print start position.

(5) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(8) Reverse feed to the print start position.

- 145 -

Page 150: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

The expansion I/O is not installed:

The strip sensor is ignored.

A

B

C

Print head positionStrip position

(1) Idling

(3) Completes printing the 1st label (A).

(5) Completes printing the 2nd label (B).

(7) Completes printing the 3rd label (C).

* The next label is printed regardless of whether the label (C) is removed or not.

(2) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(6) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(4) Reverse feed to the print start position.

*1 This issue mode differs from the issue mode D in the operation that the next label is issued regardless of whether the label is removed or not.

*2 A peripheral device, such as an applicator, must control the PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O.

*3 When the issue count is set to 2 or more when the expansion I/O has been installed, the printer continues to issue the specified number of labels as long as the PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is off.

*4 When the issue count is set to 2 or more when the expansion I/O has not been installed, the specified number of labels are issued.

- 146 -

Page 151: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(5) Print speed

• Printing takes place at the designated speed. However, the reverse feed speed in cut mode and strip mode is 3 ips. This can be changed to 2 ips in the system mode.

• The available issue speed varies according to types and sizes of the paper supply. For details, refer to the Supply Specification.

ModelParameter

1 2 3

2 ips

4 5

4 ips

6 7 8 9 A

6 ips

(6) Use of ribbon No ribbon: Thermal paper is used. (Thermal direct issue mode) Ribbon is used.: The ribbon is used. (Thermal transfer issue mode)

(7) Print orientation and mirror printing

The origin of coordinates and printing direction vary according to the designation of print orientation.

Bottom first printing

Black mark (Back side of paper)

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

Tagpitch

Tag

Paper feed direction

0X

Y

S a m p l e Effective

print length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Label

Backing paper

Effective print width

Labelpitch

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y [Labels] [Tags]

S a m p l e

- 147 -

Page 152: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Top first printing

Black mark (Back side of paper)

Effective print length

Effective print width

Tagpitch

Tag

Paper feed direction0

X

Y

Effective

print length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Label

Backing paper

Effective print width

Labelpitch

Paper feed direction0

X

Y

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

[Labels] [Tags]

Bottom first mirror printing

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Effective print length

Effective print width

Tagpitch

Tag

Paper feed direction

0X

Y

Black mark (Back side of paper)

Label

Backing paper

Effective print width

Label pitch

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y

Effective print length

[Labels] [Tags]

- 148 -

Page 153: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Top first mirror printing

Black mark (Back side of paper)

Effective print length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Label

Backing paper

Effective print width

Label pitch

Paper feed direction

[Labels] 0

X

Y

Effective print length

Effective print width

Tagpitch

Tag

Paper feed direction

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

[Tags] 0

X

Y

(8) Status response

When the option “Status response is returned.” has been selected, a status response is returned at the end of printing or if an error occurs. In the batch mode or the cut mode, the print end status response is returned after the designated number of labels have been printed. In the strip mode, a status response is returned after one label has been printed.

* Do not change the setting of the status response parameter during printing. Otherwise the status response may not be returned properly.

- 149 -

Page 154: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

S a m p l e 73.2 mm

41.0 mm

76.2 mm

15.0 mm

82.0 mm

Paper feed direction

• Issue count: 4 pieces • Cut interval: 1 piece • Paper: Tag paper (Reflective

sensor is used.) • Issue mode: Cut issue • Print speed: 4”/sec. • Ribbon: Use • Status response: On

[ESC] D0762, 0820, 0732 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T11C40 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0150, 0410, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0004, 0011C4101 [LF] [NUL]

- 150 -

Page 155: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes Process to stop the label at the home position after a head-open state is detected:

When a gap between labels (or a black mark) is detected during a head open state, the value is set again to stop each label positioned between the sensor and the print head at the home position.

A

B

C

Stop position

77 mm

92 mm

Sensor

• The labels are moved on the above condition.

Sensor

A

B

C

Stop position

• Stop position after feeding one label

A

B

C

Stop position Sensor

D

+15 mm after detection of gap between B and C

* However, an error will result when feed jam conditions are satisfied.

Paper feed direction

- 151 -

Page 156: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.15 FEED COMMAND [ESC] T

Function Feeds the paper.

Format [ESC] Tabcde [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Type of sensor 0: No sensor 1: Reflective sensor 2: Transmissive sensor 3: Transmissive sensor (when using manual threshold value) 4: Reflective sensor (when using manual threshold value)

b: Cut or non-cut 0: Non-cut 1: Cut

c: Feed mode C: Batch mode (Cut and feed when “1 (Cut)” is selected for parameter b.) D: Strip mode (with reverse feed)

E: Strip mode (with reverse feed, the strip sensor is ignored, supporting an applicator.)

d: Feed speed 2: 2 ips 4: 4 ips 6: 6 ips

e: Use of ribbon 0: No ribbon 1: Ribbon is used. 2: Ribbon is used.

Explanation (1) Type of sensor

No sensor: Paper is fed according to the parameter designated by the Label Size Set

Command.

Reflective sensor: Paper is fed according to the parameter designated by the Label Size Set

Command. However, the black mark provided on the back side of the tag paper is automatically detected by the reflective sensor and the stop position is finely adjusted.

Transmissive sensor: Paper is fed according to the parameter designated by the Label Size Set

Command. However, the label-to-label gap is automatically detected by the transmissive sensor and the stop position is finely adjusted.

- 152 -

Page 157: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Transmissive sensor (when using manual threshold value):

Paper is fed according to the parameter designated by the Label Size Set Command. However, the label-to-label gap is automatically detected by the transmissive sensor and the stop position is finely adjusted according to the value set by the threshold set operation (key operation).

Reflective sensor (when using manual threshold value)

Paper is fed according to the parameters designated by the Label Size Set Command. However, the black mark provided on the back of the tag paper is automatically detected by the reflective sensor and the paper position is finely adjusted for every piece, according to the value set by the threshold set operation (key operation).

(2) Cut/non-cut

This option is valid in the batch mode only. (Non-cut is automatically selected for the strip mode.) When the automatic forward feed standby function has been set to ON in the system mode, the printer automatically performs an approximately 14.0-mm forward feed if no subsequent command is sent from the PC in 1 second.

When the Feed Command is received in the forward feed standby state, the printer performs a reverse feed to the original position.

* Refer to the section regarding the Issue Command for precautions.

(3) Feed mode

[C: Batch (Non-cut)]

Print head position

(1) Load the paper.

(2) Completes a paper feed. (Feed to the print start position is completed and stops.)

[C: Batch (Cut)]

• “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to OFF in the system mode.

(2) Completes a paper feed. (Feed to the print start position is completed.)

Print head positionCut position

(1) Load the paper.

(3) Feeds the paper to the cut position.

(4) Cuts unnecessary paper.

(5) Reverse feed to the print start position.

- 153 -

Page 158: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[C: Batch (Cut)]

• “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to ON in the system mode.

(2) Completes a paper feed. (Feed to the print start position is completed.)

Print head positionCut position

(1) Load the paper.

(3) Feeds the paper to the cut position.

(4) Cuts unnecessary paper.

(5) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(6) After 1 second, performs 14.0-mm automatic forward feed.

[D: Strip]

Strip position Print head position

(1) Load the paper.

(2) Remove the label on the strip shaft.

(3) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(4) Starts a paper feed.

(5) Completes the paper feed. (Feed to the print start position is completed and stopped.)

- 154 -

Page 159: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[E: Strip (Feed mode: E)]

Expansion I/O has been installed: The strip sensor is ignored. A feed is performed by checking the PAUSE signal of

the expansion I/O.

Print head positionStrip position

(1) Load the paper. The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned ON.

(2) Remove the label. The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned OFF.

(4) Completes a paper feed. (Feed to the print start position is completed and stops.) The PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O is turned ON.

(3) Reverse feed to the print start position.

Expansion I/O is not installed: The strip sensor is ignored. A feed is performed.

Print head positionStrip position

(1) Load the paper.

(2) Reverse feed to the print start position

(3) Feed to the print start position is completed and stopped.

*1 The feed mode E differs from the feed mode D in the operation that the next label is fed regardless of whether the label is removed or not.

*2: A peripheral device, such as an applicator, must control the PAUSE signal of the expansion I/O.

- 155 -

Page 160: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(4) Feed speed

• A paper feed is performed at the designated speed. However, the reverse feed speed in the cut mode or the strip mode is 3 ips. This can be changed to 2 ips in the system mode.

• The available issue speed varies according to types and sizes of the paper supply. For details, refer to the Supply Specification.

ModelParameter

1 2 3

2 ips

4 5

4 ips

6 7 8 9 A

6 ips

(5) Use of ribbon

No ribbon: The ribbon motors are not operated during paper feed.

Ribbon is used.: The ribbon motors are operated during paper feed.

Notes (1) If the label size, type of sensor, feed amount fine adjustment, cut position fine adjustment (or strip position fine adjustment), or reverse feed amount fine adjustment is changed, the Feed Command must be sent to adjust the print start position prior to printing by feeding one label.

(2) The parameter of the Feed Command is stored in memory (retained even if the power is turned off).

(3) When “status response is returned.” has been selected in the Issue Command parameter setting, a status response is returned after the end of feed or when an error occurs.

(4) For explanation of the process to stop the label at the print start position, refer to the section regarding the Issue Command.

(5) When “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to ON in the system mode, the printer automatically performs 14.0-mm forward feed if no subsequent command is sent from the PC in 1 second after the last label has been fed. When the Feed Command is received during the forward feed standby, the printer feeds the label backward to the print start position.

* Refer to the section regarding the Issue Command for precautions.

- 156 -

Page 161: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

76.2 mm S a m p l e

41.0 mm

73.2 mm

15.0 mm

82.0 mm

Paper feed direction

[ESC] D0762, 0820, 0732 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] AX; +010, +000, +10 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T11C40 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0150, 0410, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0004, 0011C43001 [LF] [NUL]

- 157 -

Page 162: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.16 EJECT COMMAND [ESC] IB

Function Ejects (cuts off) the label remaining between the print head and the cutter, and returns to the original position.

Format [ESC] IB [LF] [NUL]

Notes When “Automatic forward feed standby” has been set to ON in the system mode, the printer automatically performs 14.0-mm forward feed if no subsequent command is sent from the PC in 1 second after an ejection of paper.

When the Eject Command is received in the forward feed standby state, the printer feeds the label backward to the print start position first, and then ejects it.

* Refer to the section regarding the Issue Command for precautions.

Examples

Print head position

(1) Idling

(2) Completes printing the 1st label (A).

Cut position

(3) Completes printing the 2nd label (B).

(4) Completes printing the 3rd label (C).

(5) Feeds the labels to the cut position by the E

ject Command.

A

A

A

A

A B

B

B

B

C

C

C (6) Completes cutting labels.

(7) Reverse feed to the print start position.

- 158 -

Page 163: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.17 FORWARD/REVERSE FEED COMMAND [ESC] U1, [ESC] U2

Function After printing or feeding the paper, feeds the paper to the position where the paper can be cut manually.

When the next label is to be printed, feeds the paper backward to the print start position.

Format Forward Feed [ESC] U1; aaaa [LF] [NUL]

Reverse Feed [ESC] U2; aaaa [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: Forward/reverse feed amount 0030 to 2000 (in 0.1 mm units)

Notes (1) When the [FEED] key is pressed after the Forward Feed Command has been transmitted, one label is fed. And then, the printer automatically feeds the labels by the designated forward feed amount.

(2) The Forward/Reverse Feed Command is stored in memory (retained even if the power is turned off).

(3) The Forward/Reverse Feed Command is ignored in the strip mode and the cut issue mode.

(4) The forward feed is performed at the speed designated by the Issue Command or Feed Command. The reverse feed is performed at the same speed with the forward feed. However, it can be changed in the system mode.

(5) A reverse feed may not be performed as specified, depending on the print conditions. When the media sensor is used and if the label/tag pitch is almost same as the distance between the print head and the media sensor (74.3 mm), a label/tag may not be returned to the print start position, even if the same value is specified for both forward feed and reverse feed. It may result in an error. In such case, making the reverse feed amount larger than the forward feed amount can prevent this error.

- 159 -

Page 164: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

Cut position Print head position

(2) Feeds one label.

(3) Feeds the labels to the position where the label can be cut manually.

(4) Cut the label manually.

(5) Standby

(6) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(7) Prints three pieces of label A.

A

(8) Feeds the labels to the position where labels A can be cut manually.

(9) Cut labels A manually.

(10) Standby

(11) Reverse feed to the print start position.

(12) Prints one piece of label B.

(13) Feeds the labels to the position wherelabel B can be cut manually.

(14) Cut label B manually.

(15) Standby

A A

B

B

B

A A

A A A

A

(1) Idling

[ESC] T20C40 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] U1; 0120 [LF] [NUL] Cut manually. [ESC] U2; 0120 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; A [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0003, 0002C4001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] U1; 0120 [LF] [NUL] Cut manually. [ESC] U2; 0120 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0001, 0002C4001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] U1; 0120 [LF] [NUL]

- 160 -

Page 165: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.18 STORAGE AREA ALLOCATE COMMAND [ESC] XF

Function Allocates the storage area in the flash ROM on the CPU board.

Format [ESC] XF; aa, bb, cc [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Size of the TrueType font storage area 00 to 24 (0 KB to 3,072 KB) (in units of 128 KB)

bb: Size of bit map writable character storage area 00 to 24 (0 KB to 3,072 KB) (in units of 128 KB)

cc: Size of BASIC file storage area 00 to 14 (0 KB to 1,792 KB) (in units of 128 KB) AA: The current BASIC file storage area and contents are retained.

Explanation (1) The total capacity of the storage area in flash ROM is variable. The minimum capacity is 3,072 KB.

In case that the size of BASIC file storage area is set in a range of “00” to “14”:

(2) When this command is received, the entire area in flash ROM on the CPU board is cleared.

(3) If this command is not sent, the storage area in flash ROM on the CPU board cannot be used.

(4) The storage areas are allocated in the following order of precedence – the TrueType font storage area, the bit map writable character storage area, and the BASIC file storage area. After these storage areas are allocated, the remaining area is used for the PC save area.

(5) If the sum of the TrueType font storage area, the bit map writable character storage area, and the BASIC file storage area, specified by this command, is 3,072 KB, the TrueType font storage area, the bit map writable character storage area, and the BASIC file storage area are allocated as specified, respectively. In this case, however, there is no PC save area.

(6) If the sum of TrueType font storage area, the bit map writable character storage area, and the BASIC file storage area, specified by this command, exceeds 3,072 KB, the TrueType font storage area is allocated as specified with the highest priority. Then, the remaining area is allocated to the bit map writable character storage area. If there is still remaining area after the TrueType font storage area and the bit map writable character storage area are allocated, it is used for the BASIC file storage area. There is no PC save area.

(7) When “00” (0 KB) is specified for each of the TrueType font storage area, the bit map writable character storage area, and the BASIC file storage area, the storage area is not allocated.

(8) When “14” (896 KB) is specified for any of the TrueType font storage area, the bit map writable character storage area, and the BASIC file storage area, the entire storage areas are occupied by that area. For example, if “14” is specified for the TrueType Font storage area, the entire storage areas are used for the TrueType Font storage area. The bit map writable character storage area, the BASIC file storage area, and the PC save area cannot be allocated.

- 161 -

Page 166: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

In case that the size of BASIC file storage area is set to “AA”:

(9) When this command is received, the BASIC file storage area is reserved and the other areas in flash ROM on the CPU board are cleared.

(10) If this command is not sent, the storage area in flash ROM on the CPU board cannot be used. If “AA” is set for the size of the BASIC file storage area with the BASIC file storage area being unallocated, the BASIC file storage area remains unallocated.

(11) The storage areas except for the BASIC file storage area are allocated in the following order of precedence – the TrueType font storage area, and the bit map writable character storage area. After these storage areas are allocated, the remaining area is used for the PC save area.

(12) If the sum of the TrueType font storage area and the bit map writable character storage area, specified by this command, is equal to the size of ‘3,072 KB minus the BASIC file storage area size’, the TrueType font storage area and the bit map writable character storage area are allocated as specified. In this case, however, there is no PC save area.

(13) If the sum of TrueType font storage area and the bit map writable character storage area, specified by this command, exceeds the size of ‘3,072 KB minus the BASIC file storage area size’, the TrueType font storage area is allocated as specified with the highest priority. Then, the remaining area is allocated to the bit map writable character storage area. There is no PC save area.

(14) When “00” (0 KB) is specified for each of the TrueType font storage area and the bit map writable character storage area, the storage area is not allocated.

(15) If the size of ‘3,072 KB minus the BASIC file storage area size’ or more is specified for either the TrueType font storage area or the bit map writable character storage area, each area other than the BASIC file storage area is allocated as specified. For example, when setting “20” or “21” for the size of the TrueType font storage area while the BASIC file storage area secures “4” (512KB), the entire storage areas except the BASIC file storage area are allocated to the TrueType font storage area. There is no bit map writable character storage area or PC save area.

Refer to • Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD) • Save Start Command ([ESC] XO) • Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1) • 2-byte Writable Character Code Range Command ([ESC] XE)

Example The TrueType font storage area and bit map writable character storage area are set to 768 KB and 512 KB, respectively.

(PC save area: 3,072 KB − 768KB − 512 KB = 1,792 KB)

[ESC] XF; 05, 04, 00 [LF] [NUL]

- 162 -

Page 167: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.19 FLASH MEMORY FORMAT COMMAND [ESC] J1

Function Formats (initializes) the flash ROM on the CPU board for storage.

Format [ESC] J1; a (, b) [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Formatting (initializing) range A: Entire areas of the flash memory

B: PC save area of the flash memory C: Writable character storage area of the flash memory

b: Drive (Omissible. When omitted, the flash ROM on the CPU board is selected.)

0: Flash ROM on the CPU board

Explanation (1) When using a new flash memory, the area to be used must be formatted (initialized) before the PC interface command or writable characters are stored.

(2) After the flash memory is formatted, the remaining memory capacity is displayed on the LCD.

(3) When the already stored data (PC interface commands, writable characters, logos) is stored again, the memory is consumed every time data is stored, unless the Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1) is transmitted.

(4) When a label issue operation is performed after the Flash Memory Format Command is sent, the image buffer is automatically cleared.

(5) When storing of writable characters, logos, or PC interface commands is not continued for about 10 seconds, the printer automatically enters the online mode (label issue operation). At this time, the image buffer is automatically cleared.

Refer to • Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD) • Save Start Command ([ESC] XO) • Save Terminate Command ([ESC] XP)

Example [ESC] J1; A, 0 [LF] [NUL]

- 163 -

Page 168: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.20 2-BYTE WRITABLE CHARACTER CODE RANGE COMMAND [ESC] XE

Function Sets the code range when a 2-byte writable character code is stored in the flash ROM on the CPU board.

Format [ESC] XE; a1a1a1a1, b1b1b1b1, a2a2a2a2, b2b2b2b2 ------, anananan, bnbnbnbn [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: First character code for each range 2020 to FFFF (Indicates the hex. data in ASCII code.)

bbbb: No. of characters for each range 0001 to 4000 (Indicates the hex. data in ASCII code.)

Explanation (1) For a 2-byte character code such as Kanji, the character code range may be divided into two or more. As the control information area for the unnecessary codes can be deleted by designating the character code range, the capacity of flash memory can be used efficiently.

(2) The total number of characters for each range must not exceed 0x4000 (16384 characters).

(3) Up to 2700 ranges can be designated.

(4) It is not possible to store the character codes which are not conforming to the setting for this command.

(5) The first character code for each area should be sent in the ascending order. The areas must not overlap. If these conditions are not satisfied, the operation is not guaranteed.

Refer to • Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1) • Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD)

Example In case that Shift JIS 8140H to 83DFH: Character data is present. Character data is not present.

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F8140 : 81F0 : 8240 : 82F0 : 8340 : 83D0

[ESC] XE; 8140, 00BD, 8240, 00B7, 8340, 00BD [LF] [NUL]

- 164 -

Page 169: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.21 BIT MAP WRITABLE CHARACTER STORE COMMAND [ESC] XD

Function Stores writable characters and logos in the flash ROM on the CPU board.

Format [ESC] XD; (Sj, ) aa, b, ccc, ddd, eee, fff, ggg, h, iii ------ iii [LF] [NUL]

Term Sj: Drive in which writable characters or logos are stored (Omissible. When omitted, the flash ROM on the CPU board is selected.) j: Drive 0: Flash ROM on the CPU board

aa: Writable character types 01 to 40 41 16 × 16 (dots) 42 24 × 24 (dots) 43 32 × 32 (dots) 44 48 × 48 (dots) 51 2-byte code character

b(b): Writable character code 20H to FFH (Set in hex.) 40H to 7EH, 80H to FCH (When the writable character set is 41 to 44) 2020H to FFFFH (When the writable character type is 51.)

ccc: Left offset 000 to 719 (in units of dots)

ddd: Top offset 000 to 719 (in units of dots)

eee: Character width 001 to 720 (in units of dots)

fff: Character height 001 to 720 (in units of dots)

ggg: Character-to-character spacing/proportional spacing 000 to 999 (in dots)

h: Type of writable character data 0: Nibble mode (4 bits/byte) 1: Hex. mode (8 bits/byte)

iii --- iii: Writable character data to be stored

* When the writable character type is 41 to 44, left offset, top offset, character width, character height, and character-to-character spacing/proportional spacing are fixed to “000”. Any settings are ignored.

- 165 -

Page 170: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Explanation (1) Type of writable character

Up to 44 types of writable character sets can be stored. However, the maximum number of characters varies depending on the writable character size and number of characters because of the limited memory capacity. For writable character types 41 to 44, each writable character size is fixed.

(2) Character code

Up to 224 characters can be stored per character type. The maximum number of characters are 40 types × 224 characters = 8960 characters. It varies depending on the writable character size and the number of characters because of the limited memory capacity. A character code of the character types 41 to 44 is stored in 1 byte. However, when it is called up, F0H is added to the upper digit, so a character code consists of 2 bytes. In this case, up to 188 characters can be stored per character type.

(3)

Top offset

Char. height

Reference point

Char. width

Character-to-character spacing/ proportional spacing

Left offset

Base line

Reference point of next char.

- 166 -

Page 171: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(4) Writable character types: 01 to 40, 51 to 55

8

4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4

Char. height 31 dots

Char. width 26 dots

8 8 8

Nibble mode

1 30H 2 30H 3 30H 4 3FH 5 3CH 6 30H 7 30H 8 30H

9 3FH 10 3CH 11 37H •

• 240 30H

241 3FH 242 3FH 243 3FH 244 3CH 245 30H 246 30H 247 30H 248 30H

Hex. mode

1 00H 2 0FH 3 C0H 4 00H

5 FCH 6 7FH

• 120 00H

121 FFH 122 FCH 123 00H 124 00H

[Nibble mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into four dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 248). (The upper digit: “3”)

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 30H to 3FH.

(3) The minimum unit in the X direction is 8 dots. Dots with no data are transmitted as data 0.

(4) The data count of writable characters to be stored must be as follows: Data count of writable characters to be stored = {(No. of char. width dots + 7)/8} × No. of char. height dots × 2 * The value in the brackets is rounded down to the nearest whole number.

[Hex. mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into eight dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 124).

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 00H to FFH.

(3) The minimum unit in the X direction is 8 dots. Dots with no data are transmitted as data 0.

(4) The data count of writable characters to be stored must be as follows: Data count of writable characters to be stored = {(No. of char. width dots + 7)/8} × No. of char. height dots * The value in the brackets is rounded down to the nearest whole number.

- 167 -

Page 172: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes

(1) Different character width and character height can be designated for the same writable character type, according to the writable character codes. In other words, character size can be changed by each character, thus memory can be saved.

(2) Proportional spacing and descending characters are possible depending on the parameters of character-to-character spacing/proportional spacing, left offset, and top offset.

(3) When top offset is 000, the reference coordinate is positioned at the upper left when drawing because the base line is at the top. (Coordinate setting is facilitated for logos.)

(5) Writable character type: 41 (16 dots ×16 dots )

Character width 16 dots

Character height 16 dots

4 4 4 4

8 8

Nibble mode

1 30H 2 30H 3 30H 4 30H

5 30H 6 31H 7 38H

58 31H 59 38H 60 30H

61 30H 62 30H 63 30H 64 30H

Hex. mode

1 00H 2 00H 3 01H 4 80H

5 01H 6 80H 7 01H

26 80H 27 01H 28 80H

29 01H 30 80H 31 00H 32 00H

[Nibble mode] (1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into four dot units and sent in

above-mentioned order (1 → 64). (Upper digit: “3”)

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 30H to 3FH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 64 bytes.

[Hex. mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into eight dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 32).

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 00H to FFH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 32 bytes.

* When writable character type 41 is designated, the width and height of the character are both 16 dots.

- 168 -

Page 173: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(6) Writable character type: 42 (24 dots ×24 dots )

Character width 24 dots

Character height 24 dots

444 4 4 4

8 8 8

Nibble mode

1 30H 2 30H 3 30H 4 30H 5 30H 6 30H

7 30H 8 30H 9 33H

• 137 30H 138 30H

139 30H 140 30H 141 30H 142 30H 143 30H 144 30H

Hex. mode

1 00H 2 00H 3 00H

4 00H 5 3CH 6 00H

67 00H 68 3CH 69 00H

70 00H 71 00H 72 00H

[Nibble mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into four dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 144). (Upper digit: “3”)

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 30H to 3FH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 144 bytes.

[Hex. mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into eight dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 72).

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 00H to FFH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 72 bytes.

* When writable character type 42 is designated, the width and height of the character are both 24 dots.

- 169 -

Page 174: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(7) Writable character type: 43 (32 dots ×32 dots)

Character width 32 dots

Character height 32 dots

444 4 4 4 4 4

8 8 8 8

Nibble mode

1 30H 2 30H 3 30H 4 30H 5 30H 6 30H 7 30H

8 30H 9 30H 10 30H 11 30H 12 37H

• 248 30H 249 30H

250 30H 251 30H 252 30H 253 30H 254 30H 255 30H 256 30H

Hex. mode

1 00H 2 00H 3 C0H 4 00H

5 00H 6 07H 7 C0H

123 C0H 124 00H

125 00H 126 00H 127 00H 128 00H

[Nibble mode] (1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into four dot units and sent in

above-mentioned order (1 → 256). (Upper digit: “3”)

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 30H to 3FH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 256 bytes.

[Hex. mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into eight dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 128).

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 00H to FFH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 128 bytes.

* When writable character type 43 is designated, the width and height of the character are both 32 dots.

- 170 -

Page 175: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(8) Writable character type: 44 (48 dots ×48 dots)

Character width 48 dots

Character height 48 dots

444444 4 4 44 4 4

8 8 8 8 8 8

Nibble mode

1 30H 2 30H 3 30H 4 30H 5 30H 6 30H

7 30H 8 30H 9 30H 10 30H

• 569 30H 570 30H

571 30H 572 30H 573 30H 574 30H 575 30H 576 30H

Nibble mode

1 00H 2 00H 3 00H 4 00H 5 00H 6 00H

7 00H 8 00H 9 07H 10 E0H

• 281 00H 282 00H

283 00H 284 00H 285 00H 286 00H 287 00H 288 00H

[Nibble mode] (1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into four dot units and sent in

above-mentioned order (1 → 576). (Upper digit: “3”)

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 30H to 3FH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 576 bytes.

[Hex. mode]

(1) The writable character data to be stored is separated into eight dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 288).

(2) The data of writable characters to be stored is 00H to FFH.

(3) The data count of writable characters to be stored should be 288 bytes.

* When writable character type 44 is designated, the width and height of the character are both 48 dots.

- 171 -

Page 176: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes (1) No matter what character type or character code is selected, no memory will be wasted.

(2) When a new writable character is stored, the Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1) must be transmitted.

(3) A character code already stored can be stored in the flash memory again by sending the Bit Map Writable Character Store Command ([ESC] XD, but memory will be consumed each time the code is stored. The memory can be efficiently used if the Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1) is sent in advance.

(4) If the flash memory is used, and a label issue operation is performed after sending the Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD), the image buffer is cleared automatically.

(5) When further storing operation is not continued for about 10 seconds after storing the writable character and logos, the printer automatically enters the online mode (label issue operation). In this case, when the flash memory was used, the image buffer will be cleared automatically.

Refer to Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1)

- 172 -

Page 177: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples Writable character type: 03 Writable character code: 70H

Top offset

22 dots

Char. height 31 dots

Reference point

Char. width 26 dots

Character-to-character spacing/proportional spacing: 30 dots

Left offset 2 dots

Base line

Reference point of next char.

[ESC] J1; C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XD; 03, p, 002, 022, 026, 031, 030, 0, 000?<000?<7??800?<???<00?=?03>001?

<00?001?8007001?0007801>0003801>0003<01<0001<01<0001<01<0001<01<0001<01<0001<01>0001<01>0003<01>0003801?0007801?800?001?<01?001=?07>001<???<001<7??8001<0?< 0001<0000001<0000001<0000001<000000???<0000???<0000???<0000 [LF] [NUL]

3FH = ”?” 3EH = ”>” 3DH = ”=” 3CH = ”<” 3BH = ”;” 3AH = ”:” 39H = ”9” 38H = ”8” 37H = ”7” 36H = ”6” 35H = ”5” 34H = ”4” 33H = ”3” 32H = ”2” 31H = ”1” * 30H = ”0”

- 173 -

Page 178: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.22 GRAPHIC COMMAND [ESC] SG

Function Draws graphic data.

Format [ESC] SG; aaaa(D), bbbb(D), cccc, dddd, e, ggg --- ggg [LF] [NUL] or [ESC] SG0; aaaa(D), bbbb(D), cccc, dddd, e, ffff, ggg --- ggg [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa(D): X-coordinate of the print origin for drawing graphic data Fixed as 4 digits (in 0.1 mm units) * If “D” is attached after a 4-digit value, the coordinate is specified in dots. 0000D or greater

bbbb(D): Y-coordinate of the print origin for drawing graphic data 4 or 5 digits (in 0.1 mm units)

* If “D” is attached after a 4- or 5-digit value, the coordinate is specified in dots. 0000D or greater

cccc: No. of graphic width dots Fixed as 4 digits (in units of dots)

However, when the graphic data “2: BMP file” or “6: PCX file” is selected, this designation is ignored. (The information of the graphic width is contained in the graphic data.)

dddd: No. of graphic height dots 4 or 5 digits (in units of dots)

However, when the graphic data “2: BMP file” or “6: PCX file” is selected, this designation is ignored. (The information of the graphic width is contained in the graphic data.)

When “3: TOPIX compression mode” is selected for the type of graphic data:

Resolution of graphic data: *only two types 0150: 150 DPI (The data is drawn in double resolution.) 0300: 300 DPI (The data is drawn in single resolution.)

e: Type of graphic data

When the command starts with “[ESC] SG;”: 0: Nibble mode (4 dots/byte) Overwrite drawing 1: Hex. mode (8 dots/byte) Overwrite drawing 2: BMP file mode Overwrite drawing 3: TOPIX compression mode Overwrite drawing 4: Nibble mode (4 dots/byte) OR drawing 5: Hex. mode (8 dots/byte) OR drawing 6: PCX file mode Overwrite drawing

7: TOPIX compression mode XOR drawing

When the command starts with “[ESC] SG0;”: A: Printer driver compression mode Overwrite drawing

- 174 -

Page 179: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

ffff: Data count (Effective only for the command starting with “[ESC] SG0;”) Fixed as 4 digits Represents the total number of bytes for the compressed graphic data by 32-bit hex. code. Range: 0 to 4,294,967,295 bytes (00H, 00H, 00H, 00H to FFH, FFH, FFH, FFH)

ggg --- ggg: Graphic data

Explanation (1) When the graphic data “0”, “1”, “2”, “3”, “6”, or “A” is selected, the graphic data is drawn by overwriting the image buffer.

(2) When the graphic data “4” or “5” is selected, the graphic data is drawn by carrying out OR between the graphic data and the data in the image buffer.

Effective print width

[Print direction: Top first]

Paper feed direction

0

Y

X

Print origin of coordinates

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Graphic height dotsEffective

print length

Graphic width dots

[Print direction: Bottom first]

Effective print width

Paper feed direction

0 X

Y

Effective print length

Origin of coordinates

(0, 0)

Backing paper

Label

Backing paper

Label

Graphic width dots

Print origin of coordinates

Graphic height dots

- 175 -

Page 180: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

8 8 8

Graphic width 19 dots Print origin of coordinates

Graphic height

22 dots

4 4 4 4 4 4

Nibble mode

1 30H 2 30H 3 33H 4 30H 5 30H 6 30H

7 30H 8 30H •

• 126 30H

127 33H 128 3FH 129 30H 130 30H 131 30H 132 30H

Hex. mode

1 00H 2 30H 3 00H

4 00H 5 38H

63 00H

64 3FH 65 00H 66 00H

[Nibble mode]

(1) The graphic data is separated into four dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 132). (Upper digit: “3”)

(2) The graphic data is 30H to 3FH.

(3) The minimum unit in the X direction is 8 dots. Dots with no data are transmitted as data 0.

(4) The graphic data count must be as follows: Graphic data count = {(No. of graphic width dots + 7)/8} × No. of graphic height dots × 2

* The value in the brackets is rounded down to the nearest whole number.

[Hex. mode]

(1) The graphic data is separated into eight dot units and sent in above-mentioned order (1 → 66).

(2) The graphic data is 00H to FFH.

(3) The minimum unit in the X direction is 8 dots. Dots with no data are transmitted as data 0.

(4) The graphic data count must be as follows: Graphic data count = {(No. of graphic width dots + 7)/8} × No. of graphic height dots

* The value in the brackets is rounded down to the nearest whole number.

- 176 -

Page 181: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[When TOPIX compression mode is selected]

L1L1 Length Graphic data

L2

L3

First line Second line Range for length

(1) Length: Total number of bytes of the graphic data (0001H ~ )

Example. Length = 20 bytes: 1 40 0

(2) L1 parameter: Shows in which large block (512 dots/block) the changed data is contained.

4 01235 6 7

L1

512 dots512 dots512 dots

0: Not present 1: Present

(3) L2 parameter: Shows in which medium block (64 dots/block) the changed data is contained (of the L1 large block).

4 012 3 5 6 7

L2

64 dots64 dots

0: Not present 1: Present

(4) L3 parameter: Shows in which small block (8 dots/block) the changed data is contained (of the L2 medium block).

Exclusive-OR is carried out between the current image data and the

image data one line previous. Only the changed bit is set to ON (1). The alignment of dots is MSB (left dots) and LSB (right dots).

* The graphic width for only the smaller value of either the designated value or the max. buffer size (512 KB) is drawn. The minimum unit of the data drawing is 8 dots (1 byte). If the graphic width is set to 3 dots, it will be reset to 8 dots (1 byte).

64 dots

4 012 3 5 6 7

L3

8 dots 8 dots 8 dots

0: Not present 1: Present

- 177 -

Page 182: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[When the printer driver compression mode is selected]

(1) For the command starting with ”[ESC] SG0;”, only “A: Printer driver compression mode” can be selected for the type of graphic data. The parameter for the data count is attached after the parameter for the type of graphic data. When the total number of data cannot be provided by the printer driver, “00H, 00H, 00H, 00H” should be specified for the number of graphic data. However, in this case, the printer diver cannot support printing through a serial interface (RS-232C).

(2) How to compress data

Compression is performed for every data of one line specified for the number of graphic width dots.

The data is made up in units of 8 dots. A repeated value is encoded in 2 bytes. The first byte is a numeric value “n” indicating that a value is repeated (-n + 1) times.

The range is between -127 and -1. The second byte is the repeated value. If a value is not repeated, the first byte is the numeric value “m”. The length of the values is

indicated by (m+1). The range of “m” is between 0 and 126. The length of the repetition of the value “n” should not exceed 127, and ”m” should not exceed 126, respectively.

If it exceeds the specified value, it should be divided into blocks of repetition. When a line of the same contents appears repeatedly, the number of such lines is encoded

in 2 bytes. The first byte is fixed as 127. The second byte indicates “N” times that the line of the same contents is repeated. Its range is between 1 and 255. “N” should not exceed 255. If it exceeds 255, one-line data should be newly compressed, and the remaining number of repetitions should be encoded.

[Example]

Data before being compressed (Width: 120 dots, Height: 300 lines)

Line No. Graphic data

1 AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh BBh CCh DDh EEh FFh FFh FFh FFh

2 AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh BBh CCh DDh EEh FFh FFh FFh FFh

299 AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh BBh CCh DDh EEh FFh FFh FFh FFh

300 AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh AAh BBh CCh DDh EEh FFh FFh FFh FFh

- 178 -

Page 183: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Data after being compressed

Line No. Graphic data

1 FAh AAh 03h BBh CCh DDh EEh FEh FFh2 to 256 7FH FFH 257 FAh AAh 03h BBh CCh DDh EEh FEh FFh258 to 300 7FH 2BH

FEh = -2 -(-2) + 1 = 3 FFh is repeated 3 times.

03h = 3 3 + 1 = 4 4-byte data (BBh CCh DDh EEh) without repetition

FAh = -6 -(-6) + 1 = 7 AAh is repeated 7 times.

- 179 -

Page 184: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Notes (1) The print origin of coordinates must be set so that the result of drawing the graphic data will be within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D).

(2) The number of graphic width dots and the number of graphic height dots must also be set so that the result of drawing the graphic data will be within the effective print area set by the Label Size Set Command ([ESC] D) in the same manner as the above.

(3) Both width and height are 8 dots/mm in case of the 203 dpi-print head model, and 11.8 dots/mm in case of the 300 dpi-print head model, respectively.

(4) The actual result of drawing may deviate within ±0.5 mm in case of the 203 dpi-print head model, and ±0.33 mm in case of the 300 dpi-print head model, respectively, in the X direction with respect to the designated print origin of the X-coordinate.

To draw the received graphic data at high speed, the data is directly developed in the image buffer without applying correction to each bit with respect to the designated X-coordinate. Consequently, an error of up to 4 bits occurs.

[Effective print area] [mm] Model

203 dpi print head 300 dpi print head

Issue mode Item

Batch Strip Cut Batch Strip Cut

Print head dot density 8 dots/mm (203 dpi) 11.8 dots/mm (300 dpi) Print head width 104.0 mm 105.7 mm

Min. 10.0 10.0 G: Effective print width

Max. 104.0 105.7 Min. 6.0 21.4 11.0 6.0 21.4 11.0

Label Max. 995.0 991.0 995.0 991.0 Min. 8.0 --- 11.0 8.0 --- 11.0

H: Effective print length

Tag Max. 997.0 --- 997.0 997.0 --- 997.0

- 180 -

Page 185: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples

Origin (0, 0)

Graphic width 19 dots

Graphic height

22 dots

24.0 mm

10.0 mm

[ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] SG; 0100, 0240, 0019, 0022, 0, 003000003800003<00003>000037000033800031

<00030<00030>00030600030>00030<00031<00033800?33003??0007??000???000?? >000??>0007? <0003?0000 [LF] [NUL]

[ESC] XS; I, 0001, 0002C3000 [LF] [NUL]

* 30H = “0” 38H = “8” 31H = “1” 39H = “9” 32H = “2” 3AH = “:” 33H = “3” 3BH = “;” 34H = “4” 3CH = “<” 35H = “5” 3DH = “=” 36H = “6” 3EH = “>” 37H = “7” 3FH = “?”

- 181 -

Page 186: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

[TOPIX compression mode]

Origin (0, 0)

Graphic width 19 dots

Graphic height

22 dots

24.0 mm

10.0 mm

[ESC] SG; 0100, 0240, 0019, 0300, 3, 00 5C 80 80 40 30 Length L1 L2 L3 Data (1st line)

80 80 40 08 80 80 40 04 80 80 40 02 80 80 40 09 (2nd line) (3rd line) (4th line) (5th line)

80 80 60 04 80 80 80 60 02 40 80 80 40 01 80 80 20 20 (6th line) (7th line) (8th line) (9th line)

80 80 20 80 80 80 20 80 80 80 20 20 80 80 40 01 (10th line) (11th line) (12th line) (13th line)

80 80 60 02 40 80 80 A0 0F 80 80 80 C0 30 C3 80 80 80 40 (14th line) (15th line) (16th line) (17th line)

80 80 80 80 80 80 40 10 00 80 80 C0 80 20 80 80 C0 40 C0 [LF] [NUL] (18th line) (19th line)(20th line) (21st line) (22nd line)

- 182 -

Page 187: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.23 SAVE START COMMAND [ESC] XO

Function Declares the start of saving PC interface commands. (Places the printer in the mode where PC interface commands are written in the flash memory.)

Format [ESC] XO; aa, (Sb, ) c [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Identification number to be used for saving in flash memory or calling 01 to 99

Sb: Drive in which the PC interface command is stored (Omissible. If omitted, the flash ROM on the CPU board is selected.)

b: Drive

0: Flash ROM on the CPU board

c: Status response at save time 0: No status response 1: Status response is returned.

Notes (1) After sending the Save Start Command ([ESC] XO), any command other than the following will be saved into flash memory without being analyzed.

• Save Start Command ([ESC] XO) • Save Terminate Command ([ESC] XP) • Saved Data Call Command ([ESC] XQ, [ESC] XT) • Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD, [ESC] XA) • Reset Command ([ESC] WR) • Status Request Command ([ESC] WS) • Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1)

(2) No error check is made for the commands when saving them.

(3) Up to 64 KB can be saved per save.

Refer to • Save Terminate Command ([ESC] XP) • Flash Memory Format Command ([ESC] J1)

Examples [ESC] J1; B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XO; 01, 0 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] D0508, 0760, 0468 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T20C30 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0200, 0125, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC002; 0650, 0550, 2, 2, G, 33, B, +0000000001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XP [LF] [NUL]

- 183 -

Page 188: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.24 SAVE TERMINATE COMMAND [ESC] XP

Function Declares the termination of saving PC interface commands.

Format [ESC] XP [LF] [NUL]

Note If the storing operation is not continued for about 10 seconds after the PC interface command is stored, the printer enters the online mode (label issue operation). In this case, the image buffer will be cleared automatically.

Refer to Save Start Command ([ESC] XO, [ESC] XV)

- 184 -

Page 189: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.25 SAVED DATA CALL COMMAND [ESC] XQ

Function Calls PC interface commands saved in flash memory.

Format [ESC] XQ; aa, (Sb,) c, d [LF] [NUL]

Term aa: Identification number of the file to be called from the flash memory 01 to 99

Sb: Drive from which the command is called (Omissible. When omitted, the flash ROM on the CPU board is selected.)

b: Drive 0: Flash ROM on the CPU board

c: Status response when the data is called up 0: No status response 1: Status response is returned.

d: Automatic call at power on time L: Automatic call M: No automatic call

Notes (1) If the relevant save identification number is not found, an error will result.

(2) If no save identification number is found at power on time when the automatic call has been specified, the setting of the automatic call will change to ‘No automatic call’, causing no error.

(3) If a command error is found in the PC interface command that was called by the Saved Data Call Command or the automatic call at power on time, a command error will result. After an error has occurred, the power must be turned off. When the power is turned on again, the setting for the automatic call at power on time changes to ‘No automatic call’.

(4) The printer enters the online mode (label issue operation) when the Save Data Call Command is sent after the Save Terminate Command.

Refer to • Save Start Command ([ESC] XO) • Save Terminate Command ([ESC] XP)

Examples [ESC] XQ; 01, 0, L [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC002; 100 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C3000 [LF] [NUL]

- 185 -

Page 190: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.26 HEAD BROKEN DOTS CHECK COMMAND [ESC] HD

Function Checks the thermal head for broken elements.

Format [ESC] HD001 (, a) [LF] [NUL]...... The all thermal elements are checked.

[ESC] HD003, s1s1s1s1, e1e1e1e1, s2s2s2s2, e2e2e2e2,--- s8s8s8s8, e8e8e8e8 (, a) [LF] [NUL] ............................................. The thermal elements are partially checked.

Term a: Check result status response (Omissible) A: Status is returned. (When omitted, the check result status is not returned.)

s1s1s1s1 --- s8s8s8s8: Area start coordinate Fixed as 4 digits (in units of 0.1 mm)

e1e1e1e1 --- e8e8e8e8: Area end coordinate Fixed as 4 digits (in units of 0.1 mm)

Explanation (1) The Head Broken Dots Check Command is subject to batch processing. If the Label Issue Command to issue 100 labels is transmitted before the Head Broken Dots Check Command, the head broken dots check will be executed after 100 labels have been issued.

(2) In case of the all thermal elements check, the all thermal elements of the thermal head will be checked.

(3) When the check result is found to be normal under the condition that the check result status is not returned, the next command is processed. If the check result is found to be abnormal, an error occurs. Whether or not the status is returned when an error occurs depends on the Issue Command setting.

When the check result is found to be normal under condition that the check result status is returned, a status indicating the normal end of the head broken elements check is sent. After that, the next command is processed. If the check result is found to be abnormal, a status indicating the head broken elements error is sent, and then the printer stops.

Status for normal end [SOH] [STX] “0020000” [EXT] [EOT] [CR] [LF] Status for head broken elements error [SOH] [STX] “1720000” [EXT] [EOT] [CR] [LF]

(4) The all thermal elements check takes approximately 1 second.

(5) Partial thermal elements check: • Up to 8 areas can be designated. If the number of designated areas is less than

8, the rest is omissible. • When the value set for the start coordinate is larger than the value set for the end

coordinate, the end coordinate is handled as the start coordinate, and the start coordinate is handled as the end coordinate.

• Areas can overlap each other. • Even if a coordinate is specified beyond the print head width, it will be regarded

as the maximum value, therefore, a command error does not occur.

Examples [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC002; 001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0002C3000 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] HD001 [LF] [NUL]

- 186 -

Page 191: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.27 MESSAGE DISPLAY COMMAND [ESC] XJ

Function Displays the message on the upper line of the LCD.

Format [ESC] XJ; aaa ------ aaa [LF] [NUL]

Term aaa ------ aaa: Display data (16 digits)

Explanation When the printer receives the Message Display Command, first it processes the already received data (or completes the label issue if the Issue Command has been sent). Then, it displays the message on the upper line of the LCD, and finally it enters a pause state.

When the [RESTART] key is pressed, the pause state is cleared and the LCD displays the normal message. After the pause state is cleared, the printer resumes processing the data received after the Message Display Command.

Notes (1) The number of characters to be displayed is 16. When the display data is less than 16 characters, the blanks are filled with spaces. When the display data exceeds 16 characters, the excess data is discarded.

(2) During a pause state, a halt due to an error, or a head open state, the Message Display Command is not processed even if it is received. In this case, the command is processed after the above state is cleared.

(3) The following characters can be displayed on the LCD.

If a character other than the following is received, “?” is displayed or a command error results.

2 3 4 5 6 7 A B C D 0 SP 0 @ P ` p 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 ” 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ’ 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n → F / ? O _ o ←

* The shaded parts are Japanese. They are omitted here.

- 187 -

Page 192: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Examples Load the paper. One piece of paper is fed. 4 pieces are issued.

Message, “Please set [Tag]”, is displayed. Change the paper. Press the [RESTART] key. One piece of paper is fed. 2 pieces are issued.

[ESC] D0762, 0820, 0732 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T11C40 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] PC001; 0150, 0410, 1, 1, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RC001; Sample [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0004, 0011C4001 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XJ; Please set [Tag] [LF] [NUL] [ESC] D0600, 0500, 0570 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] T11C40 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] C [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XB01; 0200, 0100, 3, 1, 03, 03, 08, 08, 03, 0, 0150 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] RB01; 12345 [LF] [NUL] [ESC] XS; I, 0002, 0011C4001 [LF] [NUL]

S a m p l e73.2 mm

41.0 mm

76.2 mm

15.0 mm

82.0 mm

57.0 mm

10.0 mm

60.0 mm

20.0 mm

50.0 mm

- 188 -

Page 193: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.28 RESET COMMAND [ESC] WR

Function Returns the printer to its initial state.

Format [ESC] WR [LF] [NUL]

Explanation The printer is returned to the same state as when the power is turned on. When the printer receives this command during printing, it returns to its initial state after issuing the label which is being printed. The next command must not be sent while the printer is performing initial processing.

Notes (1) In the system mode, any commands except the Reset Command cannot be processed.

(2) If a command error or communication error occurs when receiving the Reset Command, an error message is displayed in the online mode. However, it is not displayed in the system mode.

(3) After the code of the Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD) or the Graphic Command ([ESC] SG) is received, the Reset Command is not processed until the printer receives the data specifying the type of data.

Example [ESC] WR [LF] [NUL]

- 189 -

Page 194: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.29 STATUS REQUEST COMMAND [ESC] WS

Function Sends the printer status to the host computer.

Format [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL]

Explanation This command makes the printer send its status regardless of the setting of the status response parameter. The status to be transmitted is the current printer status, and indicates the latest status only. The remaining count indicates the remaining print count of the batch currently being printed only. No remaining count of the batch waiting to be printed is transmitted.

Notes (1) This command is available for the RS-232C, USB, Centronics interfaces, and socket communications. However, in case of the Centronics interface, the printer returns a status to the Nibble mode negotiation immediately after this command is received.

(2) The status is returned only to the interface which sent this command.

(3) After the code of the Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD) or Graphic Command ([ESC] SG) is received, the Status Request Command is not processed until the printer receives the data specifying the type of data.

(4) After receiving the Status Request Command, there may be a maximum of 20-msec. delay until the printer sends a status.

(5) At least, a 20-msec. interval must be given between the transmissions of the Status Request Command. If the next Status Request Command is transmitted within 20 msec., the printer may fail to receive it.

Example [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL]

- 190 -

Page 195: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.30 RECEIVE BUFFER FREE SPACE STATUS REQUEST COMMAND [ESC] WB

Function Sends information on the printer status and the free space of the receive buffer to the host.

Format [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL]

Explanation (1) This command makes the printer send information on its status and free space of the receive buffer, regardless of the setting of the Status Response parameter. The status to be transmitted is the current printer status, and indicates the latest status only. The remaining count indicates the remaining print count of the batch currently being printed only. No remaining count of the batch waiting to be printed is transmitted. Free space of the receive buffer for the interface which sent this command, is returned to the host.

Notes (1) This command is available for the RS-232C, USB, Centronics interfaces, and socket communications. However, in case of the Centronics interface, the printer returns a status to the Nibble mode negotiation immediately after this command is received.

(2) The printer returns the status only for the interface which sent this command.

(3) After the code of the Bit Map Writable Character Command ([ESC] XD) or Graphic Command ([ESC] SG) is received, the Status Request Command is not processed until the printer receives the data specifying the type of data.

(4) After receiving the Status Request Command, there may be a maximum of 20-msec. delay until the printer sends the status.

(5) At least, a 20-msec. interval must be given between the transmissions of the Status Request Command. If the next Status Request Command is transmitted within 20 msec, the printer may fail to receive it.

Example [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL]

- 191 -

Page 196: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.31 VERSION INFORMATION ACQUIRE COMMAND [ESC] WV

Function Sends information such as the program version of the printer.

Format [ESC] WV [LF] [NUL]

Explanation (1) The format of the program version data (27-byte data in total) to be returned to the host is as follows.

SOH 01H STX 02H

“0” 30H “1” 31H “N” 48H “O” 49H

Creation date “V” 56H “2” 32H “0” 30H “0” 30H “2” 32H “B” 42H “-“ 2DH “4” 34H

Model “8” 38H “0” 30H “SP” 20H SP 20H “V” 56H “1” 31H

Version “.” 2EH “0” 30H “A” 41H

ETX 03H EOT 04H CR 0DH LF 0AH

Creation date of the program: 9-byte data indicated in order of Day-

Month-Year

Program version: 5-byte data: Vx.xx

Revision

Version

Model: 7-byte ASCII code indicating the model

(2) This command is processed in order of receipt. This command is not processed until the processing of the commands sent prior to this command is completed. Therefore, if this command is sent while the printer is in the state other than idle, the program version data may not be returned immediately.

Notes (1) This command is effective only for the serial interface (RS-232C).

- 192 -

Page 197: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.32 PRINTER OPTION STATUS ACQUIRE COMMAND [ESC] WN

Function Sends the information what optional devices are installed, to the host.

Format [ESC] WN [LF] [NUL]

Explanation (1) The format of information to be returned to the host is as follows:

SOH STX “E” Option status ETX EOT CR LF01H 02H 45H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 03H 04H 0DH 0AH

Reserved A, B, and C

Internal serial port

30H: Not installed. 31H: RFID module (H1)

32H: RFID module (U1) Cutter

30H: Not installed.

31H: Installed. USB board

31H: Installed (Fixed)

100Base LAN board

31H: Installed (Fixed) PCMCIA Slot2

30H: Not installed. (Fixed) PCMCIA Slot1

30H: Not installed. (Fixed)

- 193 -

Page 198: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.33 IP ADDRESS SET COMMAND [ESC] IP

Function Sets the IP address to be required for the network connection.

Format [ESC] IP; a, bbb, ccc, ddd, eee [LF] [NUL]

Term a: IP address to be set 2: Printer IP address (Initial value: 192.168.10.20) 3: Gateway IP address (Initial value: 0.0.0.0) 4: Subnet mask (Initial value: 255.255.255.0)

bbb: First 8 bits: 000 to 255

ccc: Second 8 bits: 000 to 255

ddd: Third 8 bits: 000 to 255

eee: Last 8 bits: 000 to 255

Explanation The IP address setting can also be made in the system mode. The setting which was last made takes effect.

Example To set the printer IP address to “157.69.9.78”.

[ESC] IP; 2, 157, 069, 009, 078 [LF] [NUL]

- 194 -

Page 199: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.34 SOCKET COMMUNICATION PORT SET COMMAND [ESC] IS

Function Enables or disables the socket communication, and sets the communication port number to be used.

Format [ESC] IS; a, bbbbb [LF] [NUL]

Term a: 0: Socket communication is disabled. 1: Socket communication is enabled.

bbbbb: Port number (It must be set in 5 digits.) 00000 to 65535

Explanation These settings can also be made in the system mode. The setting which was last made takes effect.

Example To enable the socket communication and set the port number to “8000”.

[ESC] IS; 1, 08000 [LF] [NUL]

- 195 -

Page 200: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.35 DHCP FUNCTION SET COMMAND [ESC] IH

Function Enables or disables the DHCP function, and sets the DHCP client ID.

Format [ESC] IH; a, bbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbb [LF] [NUL]

Term a: 0: DHCP function is disabled. 1: DHCP function is enabled.

bbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbbb: DHCP client ID (16-byte data is described in 32-byte hexadecimal.)

Explanation • These settings can also be made in the system mode. The setting which was last made takes effect.

• “FFH” in the client ID is assumed as a terminator. Therefore, “FFH” must not be used in data.

• If “FFH” is specified as the first byte of the DHCP client ID, the printer assumes the DHCP client ID has not been specified. So the printer uses the MAC address of the LAN board installed on the printer as the DHCP client ID instead.

Example To enable the DHCP function and set the DHCP client ID to “12H56HCDH”.

[ESC] IH; 1, 1256CDFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF [LF] [NUL]

- 196 -

Page 201: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.36 PASS-THROUGH COMMAND [ESC] @002

Function Passes the serial interface data through the internal serial interface (CN14).

Format [ESC] @002; aaa, bbb --- bbb [LF] [NUL]

Term aaa: Number of bytes to be passed through 001 to 999

bbb --- bbb: Binary data to be passed through

Explanation This command is used to make a serial communication with the RF-ID module. The number of bytes of data specified by this command is output to the internal serial interface (CN6: RF-ID) without being processed. Data received from the internal serial interface (CN6: RF-ID) is output to the serial interface.

- 197 -

Page 202: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.3.37 INTERNAL SERIAL INTERFACE PARAMETER SET COMMAND [ESC] IZ

Function Sets communication parameters for the internal serial interface.

Format [ESC] IZ; a, b, c, d [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Communication speed 0: 2400 bps 1: 4800 bps 2: 9600 bps 3: 19200 bps

b: Data length 0: 7 bits 1: 8 bits

c: Stop bit length 0: 1 bit 1: 2 bits

d: Parity 0: None 1: Even 2: Odd

Explanation The settings by this command take effect immediately after this command has been analyzed. (A restart of the printer is not required.) This command is stored into memory and is retained even if the power is turned OFF.

When a communication error occurs on the internal serial interface, the ON LINE LED goes off and the ERROR LED goes ON. Message, “INTERNAL COM ERR”, is displayed on the upper line of the LCD, and then the printer stops due to an error.

Example To set the communication speed, the data length, the stop bit length, and the parity to 9600 bps, 8 bits, 1 bit, and even parity, respectively.

[ESC] IZ; 2, 1, 0, 1 [LF] [NUL]

- 198 -

Page 203: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.4 COMMANDS FOR SYSTEM ADMINISTRATOR

6.4.1 PARAMETER SET COMMAND [ESC] Z2; 1

Function Sets each parameter on the printer.

Format [ESC] Z2; 1, abcdefghijkklmnooppqqrstuuvwxyzABCDEFGH [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Character code selection 0: PC-850 1: PC-852 2: PC-857 3: PC-8 4: PC-851 5: PC-855 6: PC-1250 7: PC-1251 8: PC-1252 9: PC-1253 A: PC-1254 B: PC-1257 C: LATIN9 D: Arabic

b: Character “0” selection 0: 0 (without slash) 1: 0 (with slash)

c: RS-232C communication speed 0: 2400 bps 1: 4800 bps 2: 9600 bps 3: 19200 bps 4: 38400 bps 5: 115200 bps

d: RS-232C data length 0: 7 bits 1: 8 bits

e: Stop bit length 0: 1 bit 1: 2 bits

f: RS-232C parity check 0: NONE 1: EVEN 2: ODD

- 199 -

Page 204: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

g: RS-232C flow control

0: XON/XOFF protocol (XON is not output at a power on time, and XOFF is not output at a power off time.)

1: READY/BUSY (DTR) protocol (XON is not output at a power on time, and XOFF is not output at a power off time.)

2: XON/XOFF + READY/BUSY (DTR) protocol: (XON is output at a power on time, and XOFF is output at a power off time.)

3: XON/XOFF protocol: (XON is output at a power on time, and XOFF is output at a power off time.)

4: RTS protocol (XON is not output at a power on time, and XOFF is not output at a power off time.)

h: Language for LCD messages 0: ENGLISH 1: GERMAN 2: FRENCH 3: DUTCH 4: SPANISH 5: JAPANESE 6: ITALIAN

i: Automatic forward feed standby after an issue 0: OFF (Not performed) 1: ON (Performed)

j: Forward feed stanby fine adjustment direction +: Increases the amount of the forward feed −: Decrease the amount of the forward feed

kk: Fine adjustment value for the forward feed standby 00 to 50 (in units of 0.1 mm, in steps of 0.5 mm) (*1)

l: Head-up operation in the cut issue mode, or the use of the rewinder in the batch issue mode.

0 or 1: Setting is ignored.

m: Ribbon saving function 0 to 2: Setting is ignored.

n: Type of control code 0: Automatic selection 1: ESC, LF, NUL mode 2: {, |, } mode 3: Any set code mode

oo: 1st byte code of the control code (*2) “00” to “FF” (Specify the hex code in 2-byte ASCII code.) (*3)

pp: 2nd byte code of the control code (*2) “00” to “FF” (Specify the hex code in 2-byte ASCII code.) (*3)

- 200 -

Page 205: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

qq: 3rd byte code of the control code (*2) “00” to “FF” (Specify the hex code in 2-byte ASCII code.) (*3)

r: Strip wait status selection 0: OFF (No selection) 1: ON (with selection)

s: [FEED] key function 0: FEED: Feeds one label. 1: PRINT: Prints data of the image buffer on one label.

t: Kanji code selection 0: TYPE1 1: TYPE2

uu: Euro code setting “20” to “FF” (Specify the hexadecimal code in 2-byte ASCII code) (*3)

v: Automatic head broken dots check

0: OFF (An automatic broken dots check is not performed when the power is turned on.)

1: ON (An automatic broken dots check is performed when the power is turned on.)

w: Centronics ACK/BUSY timing setting 0: TYPE1 1: TYPE2

x: Web printer function setting 0: OFF (Web printer function is disabled.) 1: ON (Web printer function is enabled.)

y: Reset process when the nInit signal is ON 0: OFF (Reset process is not performed.) 1: ON (Reset process is performed.)

z: Ribbon near end detection setting 0: Not detected. 1: Detected when the remaining length of the ribbon is 30 m. 2: Detected when the remaining length of the ribbon is 70 m.

A: Expansion I/O operation mode setting 0: Standard mode 1: In-line mode

B: Centronics operation mode setting 0: SPP (Compatibility mode) 1: ECP (ECP mode)

C: Plug-and-play operation mode setting 0: OFF (Plug-and-play operation is disabled.) 1: ON (Plug-and-play operation is enabled.)

D: Label end/ribbon end process setting 0: TYPE1 (When the label end state is detected, the printer stops even if it is

printing a label.)

1: TYPE2 (When the label end state is detected, the printer stops after it completes printing a label.)

- 201 -

Page 206: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

E: Pre-strip process setting 0: OFF (The pre-strip process is not performed.) 1: ON (The pre-strip process is performed.)

F: Reverse feed speed setting 0: 3 ips 1: 2 ips

G: Installed solenoid type setting 0 or 1: Setting is ignored.

H: MaxiCode specification setting 0: TYPE1 (Compatible with the current version) 1: TYPE2 (Special specification)

I: Forward feed standby action 0 or 1: Setting is ignored.

Explanation (1) This command is not executed until the printer enters an idle state.

(2) With some exceptions, the parameters set by this command take effect when the power is turned on or the printer is reset.

*1: Though the values can be set in units of 0.1 mm, those actually set on the printer is 0.5-mm unit. When a value ranging from 0.0 mm to 0.4 mm is set, it will be actually set on the printer as 0.0 mm. Also when a value ranging from 0.5 mm to 0.9 mm is set, it will be actually set on the printer as 0.5 mm. This fine adjustment value is set only when parameter “i” (Forward feed standby after an issue) is set to “1” (Performed). If it is set to “0” (Not performed), this value is discarded.

*2 This fine adjustment value is set only when parameter “n” (Type of the control code) is set to “3” (Any set code mode). If it is set to any value other than “3”, this value is discarded.

*3 The hexadecimal codes are set in 2-byte ASCII code as shown below: Example 1: To set 36H: ”36” (33H, 36H) Example 2: To set 42H: ”42” (34H, 32H) Example 3: To set FFH: ”FF” (46H, 46H)

- 202 -

Page 207: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.4.2 FINE ADJUSTMENT VALUE SET COMMAND [ESC] Z2; 2

Function Sets various fine adjustment values on the printer.

Format [ESC] Z2; 2, abbbcdddeffghhhijjkllmnnoppqqrr [LF] [NUL]

Term a: Indicates the direction, forward or backward, in which a feed amount fine adjustment is to be made.

+: Backward −: Forward

bbb: Feed amount fine adjustment value 000 to 500 (in units of 0.1 mm, in steps of 0.5 mm) (*1)

c: Indicates the direction, forward or backward, in which a cut position (or strip position) fine adjustment is to be made.

+: Backward −: Forward

ddd: Fine adjustment value for the cut position (or strip position) 000 to 500 (in units of 0.1 mm, in steps of 0.5 mm) (*1)

e: Indicates whether the reverse feed is to be increased or decreased. +: Increase −: Decrease

ff: Reverse feed amount fine adjustment value 00 to 95 (in units of 0.1 mm, in steps of 0.5 mm) (*1)

g: Indicates the direction, left or right, in which the X-coordinate fine adjustment is to be made.

+: Positive direction (Right) −: Negative direction (Left)

hhh: X-coordinate fine adjustment value 000 to 995 (in units of 0.1 mm, in steps of 0.5 mm) (*1)

i: Indicates whether to increase or decrease the density in the thermal transfer print mode.

+: Increase (darker) −: Decrease (lighter)

jj: Print density fine adjustment value (for the thermal transfer print mode) 00 to 10 (in units of 1 step)

k: Indicates whether to increase or decrease the density in the direct thermal print mode.

+: Increase (darker) −: Decrease (lighter)

ll: Print density fine adjustment value (for the direct thermal print mode) 00 to 10 (in units of 1 step)

m: Fine adjustment direction for the ribbon take-up motor voltage −: Fixed as Negative (The voltage is lowered.)

nn: Fine adjustment value for the ribbon take-up motor voltage 00 to 15 (in units of 1 step)

- 203 -

Page 208: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

o: Fine adjustment direction for the ribbon feed motor voltage −: Negative (The voltage is lowered.)

pp: Fine adjustment value for the ribbon feed motor voltage 00 to 15 (in units of 1 step)

qq: Reflective sensor manual threshold fine adjustment value 00 to 40 (in units of 0.1 V)

rr: Transmissive sensor manual threshold fine adjustment value 00 to 40 (in units of 0.1 V)

Explanation (1) This command is not executed until the printer enters an idle state.

(2) With some exceptions, the parameters set by this command take effect when the power is turned on or the printer is reset.

*1: Though the value can be set in units of 0.1 mm, those actually set on the printer is 0.5-mm unit. When a value ranging from 0.0 mm to 0.4 mm is set, it will be actually set on the printer as 0.0 mm. Also when a value ranging from 0.5 mm to 0.9 mm is set, it will be actually set on the printer as 0.5 mm.

- 204 -

Page 209: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.4.3 RFID PARAMETER SET COMMAND [ESC] Z2; 3

Function Sets RFID-related parameters on the printer.

Format [ESC] Z2; 3, abcccdddeefffgghii [LF] [NUL]

Term a: RFID module type selection 0: Not installed.

1: H1 (B-9704-RFID-H1-QM) 2: U1 (B-9704-RFID-U1-US/EU)

b: RFID error tag detection 0: Not detected. 1: Detected.

ccc: Maximu number of RFID issue retries 000 to 255

ddd: Maximum number of RFID read retries 000 to 255

ee: RFID read retry time-out 00 to 99 (In units of 0.1 sec.: 0.0 sec. to 9.9 sec.)

fff: Maximum number of RFID write retries 000 to 255

gg: RFID write retry time-out 00 to 99 (In units of 0.1 sec.: 0.0 sec. to 9.9 sec.)

h: Feed direction of adjustment for retry +: Forward −: Backward

ii: Feed amount of adjustment for retry 00 to 99 (In units of 1 mm: 0 mm to 99 mm)

Only the value of −3 mm or less, or +3 mm or more becomes effective.

Explanation (1) This command is not executed until the printer enters an idle state.

(2) With some exceptions, the parameters set by this command take effect when the power is turned on or the printer is reset.

- 205 -

Page 210: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.4.4 BATCH RESET COMMAND [ESC] Z0 (zero)

Function Resets the printer.

Format [ESC] Z0 [LF] [NUL]

Explanation • This command is not executed until the printer enters an idle state.

• Some values in the Parameter Set Command ([ESC] Z2;1) and the Fine Adjustment Value Set Command ([ESC] Z2;2), will take effect when the printer is initialized. This command should be sent after the Parameter Set Command ([ESC] Z2;1) or Fine Adjustment Value Set Command ([ESC] Z2;2) is sent.

- 206 -

Page 211: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.5 EXPLANATION OF THE RFID RELATED COMMANDS

6.5.1 RFID TAG POSITION ADJUSTMENT COMMAND [ESC] @003

Function Sets the feed amount to adjust the RFID tag position before writing data onto it. If the RFID tag is not positioned just above the RFID antenna when the paper is at the print start position, the printer automatically feeds the paper forward or backward by the specified amount to write data onto the RFID tag prior to printing. After that, the printer returns the paper to the print start position for printing. Only the value of −30 or less, or +30 or more becomes effective.

Format { @003; abbb | }

Term a: Feed direction +: Forward

−: Backward

bbbb: Feed amount 0000 to 9999 (In units of 0.1 mm)

- 207 -

Page 212: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.5.2 RFID TAG READ COMMAND [ESC] WF

Function Reads the data stored on the RFID tag.

Format [ESC] WF (; Naaaa) (, Abbb) [LF] [NUL]

Term aaaa: Number of bytes to be read (Omissible) 0001 to 9999

bbb: Address of data to be read 000 to 999

Specify the address where reading the RFID tag is started. This parameter is effective for the ISO18000-6B tag only. When omitted, the value will be set to 18.

Explanation (1) When the number of bytes to be read is specified, data of specified bytes is returned regardless of the type of tag. If the volume of the read data is less than specified number of bytes, it is filled with [NUL] when returned. If the volume of the read data is exceeding the specified number of bytes, the excess data is not returned.

(2) When the number of bytes to be read is omitted, the data will be returned in accordance with the tag types, as shown in the table below.

Tag type Number of bytes returned EPC Class 0 8 bytes EPC Class 1 8 bytes

Tag-it 32 bytes I-Code 44 bytes Others 32 bytes

(3) The format of information to be returned to the host is as follows.

SOH 01H STX 02H Header of the status block

“F” 46H

30H

30H30H: Reading failed. 31H31H: I-Code 31H32H: Tag-it 31H33H: C220

Tag type

31H34H: ISO15693 31H35H: C210 31H36H: C240 32H31H: EPC Class 0 30H 32H32H: EPC Class 1 32H33H: ISO18000-6B

Data Tag data (0 byte to 9999 bytes) ETX 03H EOT 04H CR ODH Footer of the status block

LF OAH

- 208 -

Page 213: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Example Examples of the status to be returned are shown below.

[When a reading failed.]

Header “F” Tag type Footer 01H 02H 46H 30H 30H 03H 04H 0DH 0AH

Reading has failed. [When a reading succeeded.]

Header “F” Tag type Read data Footer 01H 02H 46H 32H 32H 41H 42H 43H 44H 45H 46H 47H 48H 03H 04H 0DH 0AH

Read data

“ABCDEFGH” Tag type: EPC Class 1

- 209 -

Page 214: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

6.5.3 RFID VOID PATTERN PRINT COMMAND [ESC] @006

Function Prints the void pattern to indicate an RFID tag error.

Format [ESC] @006 [LF] [NUL]

Explanation (1) The void pattern is printed according to the currently set label size. After the void pattern is printed, the print data image is still retained. This void pattern is printed when data cannot be written onto the RIFD tag properly due to breakage of RFID chip or some other reasons. The void pattern visually indicates that the RFID tag is faulty.

Usually, the void pattern is automatically printed if writing data onto the RFID tag results in an error. Therefore, this command does not need to be transmitted. This command is intended to be used if writing data onto the RFID tag failed while the BASIC interpreter or the Pass Through Command is used and the RFID module is manually controlled to issue RFID labels.

- 210 -

Page 215: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

7. CONTROL CODE SELECTION

(1) Automatic Selection This printer automatically selects [ESC] (1BH). [LF] (0AH). [NUL] (00H) or {(7BH). | (7CH).} (7DH)

as an interface command control code. After the power is turned on, the program checks the data from the host for [ESC] and { and assumes the code whichever has been sent first to be a control code.

For example, if [ESC] is sent first after the power is turned on, [ESC]. [LF]. [NUL] becomes a control code, and if “{“ is sent first, { | } becomes a control code. Control code selection is made for every command. If the control code of the first command is [ESC] ~ [LF] [NUL], followed by [ESC], the control code becomes [ESC]. [LF]. [NUL]. In the same way, if the first command is followed by “{“, the control code for the next command becomes { | }. When { | } is the control code, the data of 00H to 1FH between “{“ and “| }” is ignored. However, the data of 00H to 1FH becomes valid while processing the Graphic Command or the Bit Map Writable Character Command in hexadecimal mode. When { | } is the control code, { | } cannot be used in the data of the Data Command or the Message Display Command.

Power ON

Command processing

Read received data

<Is the code ESC?>

Yes

No

<Is the code { ?> No

Control code is assumed to be ESC. LF. NUL.

Control code is assumed to be { | }.

The read data is discarded.

Yes

(2) Manual Selection (ESC. LF. NUL) The control code of the command is [ESC] (1BH). [LF] (0AH). [NUL] (00H), and the control code

selection is not performed.

(3) Manual Selection ({ | }) The control code of the command is {(7BH). | (7CH).} (7DH), and the control code selection is not

performed. Data of 00H to 1FH is ignored and discarded in this mode. However, data of 00H to 1FH becomes valid while processing the Graphic Command or the Bit Map Writable Character Command in hexadecimal mode. When { | } is used as the control code, { | } cannot be used in the data of the Data Command or the Message Display Command.

(4) Manual Selection (Any set code) The control code of the command is the code set in the system mode, and the control code

selection is not performed. The code used in each command should not be set as the control code.

In the Data Command or the Message Display Command, the code set as the control code cannot be used.

- 211 -

Page 216: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

8. ERROR PROCESSING

If the printer detects any of the following errors, it indicates the error message (LCD, LED), returns status response (serial interface, parallel interface), and stops its operation.

8.1 COMMUNICATION ERRORS

(1) Command Errors An error results if a command length error, command transmission sequence error, command

format error, or parameter designation error is found in analyzing the command. An error also results if the Format Command of a field is not transmitted and its Data Command is transmitted. An attempt to call a PC Save Command of an unsaved save identifier results in an error. An undefined command is not detected as an error, and data is discarded until [ESC] or [{] is received.

(2) Hardware Errors A hardware error results if a framing error or parity error is found when receiving data through the

serial interface (RS-232C).

* At the moment when a command error or hardware error occurs, the printer shows the error message and returns a status response before it stops. Any commands except the Status Request Command and Reset Command are not processed. When the printer is restored by the [RESTART] key, the printer enters the initial state which is obtained after the power is turned on.

8.2 ERRORS IN ISSUING OR FEEDING

(1) Paper Jam

When the relation between the programmed label (or tag) pitch (A) and the label (or tag) pitch detected by the sensor (B) is not applicable to the following formula, an error will result: (A) × 50% ≤ (B) ≤ (A) × 150%

• A paper jam has occurred during paper feed. • The paper has not been placed properly. • The label used does not match the type of the sensor. • The reflective sensor position is not aligned with the black mark. • The actual label size does not meet the designated label length. • Label-to-label gap cannot be detected due to a preprint. • The sensor has not been properly adjusted.

(The sensor has not been adjusted using the label to be used.)

If the stripped label is not detected by the strip sensor when printing or feeding is completed in the strip mode, an error will result.

- 212 -

Page 217: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(2) Cutter Error

If the status of the cutter home position sensor has not changed for 1.5 sec. or more since the cutter motor was driven, an error will result.

• A paper jam has occurred at the cutter. (The cutter does not return to the home position.) • The cutter does not move from the home position. (3) Label End

Error processing differs depending on the setting of label end/ribbon end process in the system mode.

When TYP1 is selected (default): When the transmissive sensor or the reflective sensor detects a continuous 3-mm long label

end state, an error will result. When an issue, a feed, or an ejection is attempted in a printer stop state while the

transmissive sensor or the reflective sensor is detecting the label end state, an error will result.

When TYP2 is selected:

When the transmissive sensor or the reflective sensor detects a continuous 3-mm long label end state, the printer completes the printing in progress, and then an error will result when the next label comes to the home position.

When an issue, a feed, or an ejection is attempted in a printer stop state while the transmissive sensor or the reflective sensor is detecting the label end state, an error will result.

(4) Ribbon Error

When the ribbon rotational speed, detected by the ribbon take-up motor sensor and the ribbon feed motor sensor, deviates from specification, an error will result.

• An error occurred in the sensor which determines the torque for the ribbon motor. • A ribbon jam occurred. • The ribbon has been broken/torn. • A ribbon is not installed.

The printer stops in accordance with the label end/ribbon error handling setting in the system mode.

When TYP1 is selected (default): With the ribbon being selected, an error will result when a ribbon rotational speed deviates from specification. When TYP2 is selected:

With the ribbon being selected, when a ribbon rotational speed deviates from specification an error will result under the following conditions: If the unfinished label length is 30 mm or more, the printer prints the label for 20 mm before the error takes place. If the unfinished label length is less than 30 mm, the printer completes the unfinished label and stops printing when the next label comes to the home position.

(5) Head Open Error

If the head open sensor detects continuous 5-mm head open state, an error will result.

If the head open sensor detects the open state when an issue, a feed, or an ejection is attempted in a printer stop state, an error will result.

(6) Thermal Head Error

A broken element error has occurred on the thermal head.

An error has occurred on the thermal head driver.

- 213 -

Page 218: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(7) Thermal Head Excessive Temperature

When the ambient temperature detection thermistor detects an excessively high temperature (61 °C or more), an error will result.

When the thermal head temperature detection thermistor detects an excessively high temperature (80°C or more), an error will result.

(8) Front Cover Open Error

If the front cover open sensor detects continuous 5-mm cover open state, an error will result.

If the front cover open sensor detects the cover open state when an issue, a feed, or an ejection is attempted in a printer stop state, an error will result.

* At the moment an error occurs, the printer displays an error message, sends a status response, and then stops. Only the Status Request Command and the Reset Command can be processed. Other commands are not processed. Restoration by the [RESTART] key is possible except in case of a thermal head excessive temperature error. (The printer resumes printing the label at which the error had occurred.)

- 214 -

Page 219: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

8.3 ERRORS IN WRITABLE CHARACTER AND PC COMMAND SAVE MODES

(1) Write Error

• An error has occurred in writing data in the flash memory.

(2) Format Error

• An erase error has occurred in formatting the flash memory.

(3) Memory Full

• Further data storing is impossible because of insufficient space in the flash memory.

* At the moment when an error occurs, the printer displays an error message, sends status response, then stops. The Status Request Command and the Reset Command only can be processed and other commands are not processed. Restoration by the [RESTART] key is impossible.

8.4 SYSTEM ERRORS

(1) Momentary Power Interruption Error

• A momentary power interruption has occurred.

(2) Address error

• A command has been fetched from an odd address. • Word data has been accessed from a place other than the boundary of the word data. • Long word data has been accessed from a place other than the boundary of the long word data.

(3) General invalid command exception

• An undefined command in a place other than the delay slot has been decoded.

(4) Slot invalid exception

• An undefined command in the delay slot has been decoded. • A command which rewrites the data in the delay slot has been decoded.

* At the moment when an error occurs, the printer shows an error message, then stops. (None of the commands and key operations will be processed.)

(5) EEPROM Error

• The back-up EEPROM cannot be read/written properly.

8.5 RESET PROCESSING

When the [RESTART] key is held down for more than 3 seconds during the error which is restorable by the [RESTART] key or during a pause, the printer returns to the initial status which is obtained after the power is turned on.

- 215 -

Page 220: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

8.6 RFID ERROR

(1) RFID Write Error

• If writing data onto the RFID tag continuously failed for the maximum number of RFID write retries, an RFID write error will result. (The maximum number of RFID write retries can be set in the system mode.)

* At the moment an error occurs, the printer shows an error message, sends a status response, and then stops. Only the Status Request Command and the Reset Command can be processed. Other commands are not processed. Restoration using the [RESTART] key is possible. (The printer resumes printing the label at which the error had occurred.)

- 216 -

Page 221: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

9. STATUS RESPONSE

9.1 FUNCTIONS

There are three kinds of status response functions.

(1) Status transmission at the end of a normal issue or the occurrence of an error (automatic status transmission)

This function is available for the RS-232C interface, socket communication (during connection), and the e-mail function.

If the option “status response is returned.” has been selected, the printer sends the status to the host computer when the printer performs a feed or completes an issue normally. (For the batch/cut mode: after the designated number of labels has been printed. For the strip mode: after one label has been printed.) In the online mode, the head-up or head-down status is sent to the host computer.

When an error occurs, the status is sent to the host computer. The remaining count included in the status response indicates the remaining print count of the

batch currently in progress only. No remaining count of the batch waiting to be printed is transmitted.

(2) Status transmission in response to a status request (Status Request Command)

This function is available for the RS-232C, USB, Centronics interfaces, and socket communications.

Upon receipt of the Status Request Command, the printer sends the latest status indicating its current state to the host computer, regardless of the status response parameter setting. The remaining count indicates the remaining print count of the batch currently in progress only. No remaining count of the batch waiting to be printed is transmitted. This command is not stored in the receive buffer, but executed immediately after received.

(3) Receive buffer free space status transmission in response to a status request (Receive Buffer Free Space Status Request Command)

This function is available for the RS-232C, USB, Centronics interfaces, and socket communications.

Upon receipt of the Receive Buffer Free Space Status Request Command, the printer sends the latest status indicating its current state to the host computer, regardless of the status response parameter setting . The remaining count indicates the remaining print count of the batch currently in progress only. No remaining count of the batch waiting to be printed is transmitted. This command is not stored in the receive buffer, but executed immediately after received.

• Strip wait status

The strip wait status (05H) returned to the Status Request Command depends on the system mode setting.

When the strip wait status is set to “1 (OFF)” in the system mode: If the Status Request Command is sent while a label is on the strip shaft (for example, while idling, after feeding a label, or after printing all specified number of labels), the printer returns (00H) to the host.

When the strip wait status is set to “2 (ON)” in the system mode: If the Status Request Command is sent while a label is on the strip shaft (for example, while idling, after feeding a label, or after printing all specified number of labels), the printer returns (05H) to the host.

If the Status Request Command is sent while a label is being printed or issued, the strip wait status (05H) is returned regardless of the setting in the system mode.

- 217 -

Page 222: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

9.1.1 STATUS FORMAT

SOH STX Status Remaining count ETX EOT CR LF 01H 02H 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH 03H 04H 0DH 0AH

Remaining count • 0000 to 9999

(Fixed as 0000 in the save mode)

Type of status • “1” (31H) (In response to the Status Request Command) • “2” (32H) (Automatic status transmission)

Detail status

Status to be returned in response to the Receive Buffer Free Space Status Request Command

SOH 01H STX 02H

Header of the status block

3XH Status

3XH Printer status * Details are described later.

Status type 33H Status for the ECP mode 3XH 3XH 3XH

Remaining count

3XH

Remaining print count * Details are described later.

3XH Length

3XH Total number of bytes of this status block.

3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH

Free space of receive buffer

3XH

Free space of the receive buffer “00000” (0K byte) to “99999” (99999K bytes) However, the maximum value should be equal to the receive buffer capacity.

3XH 3XH 3XH 3XH

Receive buffer capacity

3XH

Receive buffer capacity “00000” (0K byte) to “99999” (99999K bytes) However, the maximum value differs depending on the models.

CR 0DH LF 0AH

Footer of the status block.

- 218 -

Page 223: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

9.1.2 DETAIL STATUS

Detail Status LCD Message of the Upper Line (English)

Printer Status Auto Status Transmission

Status Request Command

ON LINE The print head is closed in the head open state. 00 00 HEAD OPEN The print head is opened in the online mode. 01 01 ON LINE Operating (Analyzing command, drawing, printing,

feeding) – 02

PAUSE **** In a pause state – 04 ON LINE A label is waiting to be stripped. – 05 Display of error command (See NOTE 1.)

A command error has been found in analyzing the command.

06 06

COMMS ERROR A parity error or framing error has occurred during communication by RS-232C

07 07

PAPER JAM **** A paper jam has occurred during a paper feed. 11 11 CUTTER ERROR**** An abnormal condition has occurred at the cutter. 12 12 NO PAPER **** The paper has run out. 13 13 NO RIBBON **** The ribbon has run out. 14 14 HEAD OPEN **** An attempt was made to feed or issue with the print

head opened (except the [FEED] key). 15 15

HEAD ERROR **** A broken element has been found on the print head.

17 17

EXCESS HEAD TEMP The print head temperature has become excessively high.

18 18

RIBBON ERROR**** An abnormal condition has occurred in the sensor which determines the torque of the ribbon motor.

21 21

COVER OPEN **** An attempt was made to feed or issue with the front cover opened.

24 24

ON LINE Ribbon near end state (Online) – 27 PAUSE Ribbon near end state (In a pause state) – 28 ON LINE Ribbon near end state (Operating) – 29 ON LINE A label issue has been completed normally. 40 – ON LINE A feed has been completed normally. 41 – ON LINE A head broken dots check has been completed

normally. 00 –

SAVING ### &&&& In writable character or PC command save mode – 55

FLASH WRITE ERR. An error has occurred in writing data into the flash memory.

50 50

FORMAT ERROR An erase error has occurred in formatting the flash memory.

51 51

FLASH CARD FULL Saving failed because of insufficient space in the flash memory.

54 54

- 219 -

Page 224: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Detail Status LCD Message of

Upper Line (English)

Printer Status Auto Status Transmission

Status Request Command

INITIALIZING... The flash memory is being initialized. (Initialization is carried out for approximately 15 seconds.)

POWER FAILURE A momentary power interruption has occurred. – – EEPROM ERROR A back-up EEPROM cannot be read/written

properly. – –

SYSTEM ERROR (a) A command has been fetched from an odd address.

(b) Word data has been accessed from a place other than the boundary of the word data.

(c) Long word data has been accessed from a place other than the boundary of the long word data.

(d) An undefined command in a place other than the delay slot has been decoded.

(e) An undefined command in the delay slot has been decoded.

(f) A command which rewrites the data in the delay slot has been decoded.

– –

- Void pattern has been printed. When data cannot be written onto the RFID tag properly, the printer prints the void pattern to indicate that this tag is faulty, and then, automatically retries data write according to the setting for the maximum number of RFID write retries. When the void pattern printing is completed, the printer sends this status.

60 ---

RFID WRITE ERROR When writing data onto the RFID tag continuously failed for the maximum number of RFID write retries, the printer enters an error state and sends this status.

61 61

RFID ERROR When the printer cannot communicate with the RFID module, due to a failure of the RFID module or some other reasons, this error occurs.

62 62

- 220 -

Page 225: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

9.1.3 SUMMARY OF STATUS RESPONSE

Interface Status transmission timing Status sizeAutomatic status transmission 13 bytes Reception of [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL] 13 bytes RS-232C Reception of [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] 23 bytes Automatic status transmission N/A Nibble mode negotiation immediately after [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL] is received

13 bytes Centronics

Nibble mode negotiation immediately after [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] is received

23 bytes

Automatic status transmission N/A Reception of [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL] 13 bytes USB Reception of [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] 23 bytes Automatic status transmission 13 bytes Reception of [ESC] WS [LF] [NUL] 13 bytes Socket communications Reception of [ESC] WB [LF] [NUL] 23 bytes

E-mail function Automatic status transmission 13 bytes

- 221 -

Page 226: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

9.2 PARALLEL INTERFACE SIGNALS

9.2.1 COMPATIBILITY MODE

Output Signal LCD Messages of Upper Line (English) Printer Status

Busy Select nFault PError

ON LINE In the online mode L H H L ON LINE In the online mode (communicating) L, H H H L HEAD OPEN The print head is opened in the online mode. H L L L PAUSE **** In a pause state H L L L ON LINE Data has been set from the host while the

receive buffer is full. H H H L

ON LINE After data was set from the host with the receive buffer full, some data was processed and the buffer has free space.

L H H L

ON LINE Initialize process is in progress. (After the power is turned on or the nInit signal is received.)

H H H L

Display of error command A command error has occurred in analyzing the command.

H L L L

PAPER JAM **** A paper jam has occurred during a paper feed.

H L L L

CUTTER ERROR**** An abnormal condition has occurred at the cutter.

H L L L

NO PAPER **** The paper has run out. H L L H NO RIBBON **** The ribbon has run out. H L L H HEAD OPEN **** A feed or an issue was attempted with the

print head opened (except the [FEED] key). H L L L

HEAD ERROR **** A broken element has been found on the print head.

H L L L

EXCESS HEAD TEMP The print head temperature has become excessively high.

H L L L

RIBBON ERROR**** An abnormal condition has occurred on the sensor which determines the torque of the ribbon motor.

H L L L

COVER OPEN **** A feed or an issue was attempted with the front cover opened.

H L L L

ON LINE Ribbon near end state (Online) L H H L PAUSE Ribbon near end state (In a pause state) H L L L ON LINE Ribbon near end state (Operating) L H H L SAVING ### &&&& In writable character or PC command save

mode L H H L

FLASH WRITE ERR. An error has occurred in writing data into the flash memory.

H L L L

FORMAT ERROR An erase error has occurred in formatting the flash memory.

H L L L

FLASH CARD FULL Saving failed because of insufficient space in the flash memory.

H L L L

INITIALIZING... The flash memory is being initialized. (Initialization is carried out for approximately 15 seconds.)

- 222 -

Page 227: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Output Signal LCD Messages

of Upper Line (English)Printer Status

Busy Select nFault PError

POWER FAILURE A momentary power interruption has occurred. H L L L EEPROM ERROR A back-up EEPROM cannot be read/written

properly. H L L L

SYSTEM ERROR (a) A command has been fetched from an odd address.

(b) Word data has been accessed from a place other than the boundary of the word data.

(c) Long word data has been accessed from a place other than the boundary of the long word data.

(d) An undefined command in a place other than the delay slot has been decoded.

(e) An undefined command in the delay slot has been decoded.

(f) A command which rewrites the data in the delay slot has been decoded.

H L L L

RFID WRITE ERROR When writing data onto the RFID tag continuously failed for the maximum number of RFID write retries, the printer enters an error state and sends this status.

H L L L

RFID ERROR When the printer cannot communicate with the RFID module, due to a failure of the RFID module or some other reasons, this error occurs.

H L L L

9.3 E-MAIL

The printer is able to notify the PC of the printer status by e-mail. The statuses to be notified by e-mail are the same as those notified through the serial interface. For details, refer to the Network Specification (TAA-1401).

- 223 -

Page 228: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

10. LCD MESSAGES AND LED INDICATIONS

The model and the firmware version are displayed on the lower line of the LCD.

LED Indication

No. LCD Messages of

Upper line (English) POWER ON LINE ERROR

Printer Status

Restoration by the

[RESTART] key

Yes/No

Acceptance of Status

Request and Reset

CommandsYes/No

1 ON LINE In the online mode - Yes ON LINE In the online mode

(Communicating) - Yes

2 HEAD OPEN The print head is opened in the online mode.

- Yes

3 PAUSE **** In a pause state Yes Yes 4 COMMS ERROR A parity error or framing error has

occurred during communication by RS-232C.

Yes Yes

5 PAPER JAM **** A paper jam has occurred during paper feed.

Yes Yes

6 CUTTER ERROR**** An abnormal condition has occurred at the cutter.

Yes Yes

7 NO PAPER **** The paper has run out. Yes Yes 8 NO RIBBON **** The ribbon has run out. Yes Yes 9 HEAD OPEN **** A feed or an issue was attempted

with the print head opened (except the [FEED] key).

Yes Yes

10 HEAD ERROR A broken element has been found on the thermal head.

Yes Yes

11 EXCESS HEAD TEMP The print head temperature has become excessively high.

No Yes

12 RIBBON ERROR**** An abnormal condition has occurred on the sensor which determines the torque of the ribbon motor.

Yes Yes

13 COVER OPEN **** A feed or an issue was attempted with the front cover opened.

Yes Yes

14 SAVING ### &&&&

In writable character or PC command save mode

- Yes

15 FLASH WRITE ERR. An error has occurred in writing data into the flash ROM on the CPU board.

No Yes

16 FORMAT ERROR An erase error has occurred in formatting the flash ROM on the CPU board.

No Yes

17 FLASH CARD FULL Saving failed because of the insufficient space in the flash ROM on the CPU board.

No Yes

18 Display of error command (See NOTE 1.)

A command error has occurred in analyzing the command.

Yes Yes

- 224 -

Page 229: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

No. LCD Messages of Upper line LED Indication Printer Status

Restoration by the

[RESTART]

Acceptance of Status Request

(English) POWER ON LINE ERROR

key Yes/No

Reset Command

Yes/No 19 POWER FAILURE A momentary power interruption

has occurred. No No

20 INITIALIZING... The memory is being initialized. (Initialization is carried out for a max. of approximately 15 seconds)

– –

21 EEPROM ERROR A back-up EEPROM cannot be read/written properly.

No No

22 SYSTEM ERROR When any abnormal operations as below are performed, a system error occurs. (a) Command fetch from an odd

address (b) Access to the word data

from a place other than the boundary of the word data

(c) Access to the long word data from a place other than the boundary of the long word data

(d) Access to the area of 80000000H to FFFFFFFFH in the logic space in the user mode.

(e) Undefined command placed in other than the delay slot has been decoded.

(f) Undefined command in the delay slot has been decoded.

(g) Command to rewrite the delay slot has been decoded.

No No

23 100BASE LAN INITIALIZING...

The 100BASE LAN is being initialized.

– –

24 DHCP CLIENT INITIALIZING...

The DHCP client is being initialized.

* When the DHCP function is enabled.

– –

25 RFID WRITE ERROR Writing data onto the RFID tag continuously failed for the maximum number of RFID write retries.

Yes Yes

26 RFID ERROR The printer cannot communicate with the RFID module.

Yes Yes

- 225 -

Page 230: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

NOTE 1: When a command error has been found in the sent command, 16-byte command code of the erroneous command is displayed on the upper line of the LCD. (However, [LF] and [NUL] are not displayed.)

[Example 1] [ESC] PC001; 0A00, 0300, 2, 2, A, 00, B [LF] [NUL]

Command error LCD display PC001;0A00,0300,

B-SA4T V1.0A

[Example 2] [ESC] T20 G30 [LF] [NUL]

Command error LCD display T20G30 B-SA4T V1.0A

[Example 3] [ESC] XR; 0200, 0300, 0450, 1200, 1 [LF] [NUL]

Command error LCD display XR;0200,0300,045

B-SA4T V1.0A

NOTE 2: When the command error is displayed, “? (3FH)” is displayed for codes other than 20H to 7FH and A0H to DFH.

NOTE 3: : ON : Blinking : OFF ****: Remaining number of labels to be printed to 9999 (in units of 1 label/tag) ###: Remaining memory capacity of PC save area in the flash memory:

0 to 3,072 (in K bytes) &&&&: Remaining memory capacity of writable character storage area in the flash memory

0 to 3,072 (in K bytes)

- 226 -

Page 231: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

11. LCD MESSAGES IN DIFFERENT LANGUAGES (UPPER LINE OF LCD)

No. ENGLISH No. GERMAN No. FRENCH 1 ON LINE 1 ON LINE 1 PRETE 2 HEAD OPEN 2 KOPF OFFEN 2 TETE OUVERTE 3 PAUSE **** 3 PAUSE **** 3 PAUSE **** 4 COMMS ERROR 4 UEBERTR.-FEHLER 4 ERR. COMMUNICAT. 5 PAPER JAM **** 5 PAPIERSTAU **** 5 PB. PAPIER **** 6 CUTTER ERROR**** 6 MESSERFEHL. **** 6 PB. CUTTER **** 7 NO PAPER **** 7 PAPIERENDE **** 7 FIN PAPIER **** 8 NO RIBBON **** 8 FARBB.-ENDE **** 8 FIN RUBAN **** 9 HEAD OPEN **** 9 KOPF OFFEN **** 9 TETE OUVERTE****

10 HEAD ERROR 10 KOPF DEFEKT 10 ERREUR TETE 11 EXCESS HEAD TEMP 11 KOPF UEBERHITZT 11 TETE TROP CHAUDE 12 RIBBON ERROR**** 12 FB-FEHLER **** 12 ERREUR RUBAN**** 13 COVER OPEN **** 13 DECKEL OFFEN**** 13 ERR. CAPOT **** 14 SAVING ### &&&& 14 SP.-MOD ### &&&& 14 MEM LIB ### &&&& 15 FLASH WRITE ERR. 15 FLASH FEHLER 15 ERREUR MEM FLASH 16 FORMAT ERROR 16 FORMATFEHLER 16 ERREUR DE FORMAT 17 FLASH CARD FULL 17 FLASH ZU KLEIN 17 MEM INSUFFISANTE 18 INITIALIZING... 18 INITIALIZING... 18 INITIALIZING... 19 POWER FAILURE 19 POWER FAILURE 19 POWER FAILURE 20 EEPROM ERROR 20 EEPROM ERROR 20 EEPROM ERROR 21 SYSTEM ERROR 21 SYSTEM ERROR 21 SYSTEM ERROR 22 RFID WRITE ERROR 22 RFID WRITE ERROR 22 RFID WRITE ERROR 23 RFID ERROR 23 RFID ERROR 23 RFID ERROR

No. DUTCH No. SPANISH No. JAPANESE 1 IN LIJN 1 ON LINE 1 2 KOP OPEN 2 CABEZAL ABIERTO 2 3 PAUZE **** 3 PAUSA **** 3 4 COMM. FOUT 4 ERROR COMUNICACI 4 5 PAPIER VAST **** 5 ATASCO PAPEL**** 5 6 SNIJMES FOUT**** 6 ERROR CORTAD**** 6 7 PAPIER OP **** 7 SIN PAPEL **** 7 8 LINT OP **** 8 SIN CINTA **** 8 9 KOP OPEN **** 9 CABEZA ABIER**** 9

10 PRINTKOP DEFECT 10 ERROR DE CABEZAL 10 11 TEMP. FOUT 11 TEMP.CABEZA ALTA 11 12 LINT FOUT **** 12 ERROR CINTA **** 12 13 DEUR OPEN **** 13 TAPA ABIERTA**** 13 14 MEM ### &&&& 14 SALVAR ### &&&& 14 15 FLASH MEM FOUT 15 ERROR ESCRITURA 15 16 FORMAAT FOUT 16 ERROR DE FORMATO 16 17 GEHEUGEN VOL 17 MEMORIA INSUFICI 17 18 INITIALIZING... 18 INITIALIZING... 18 19 POWER FAILURE 19 POWER FAILURE 19 20 EEPROM ERROR 20 EEPROM ERROR 20 21 SYSTEM ERROR 21 SYSTEM ERROR 21 22 RFID WRITE ERROR 22 RFID WRITE ERROR 22 23 RFID ERROR 23 RFID ERROR

* Japanese messages are omitted here.

- 227 -

Page 232: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

No. Italian 1 PRONTA 2 TESTA APERTA 3 PAUSA **** 4 ERR. COMUNICAZ. 5 CARTA INCEP.**** 6 ERR. TAGL. **** 7 NO CARTA **** 8 NO NASTRO **** 9 TESTA APERTA****

10 ERROR TESTA 11 TEMP. TESTA ALTA 12 ERR. NASTRO **** 13 COVER OPEN **** 14 SALVA ### &&&& 15 ERR.SCRITT.CARD 16 ERR. FORMATTAZ. 17 MEM. CARD PIENA 18 INITIALIZING... 19 POWER FAILURE 20 EEPROM ERROR 21 SYSTEM ERROR 22 RFID WRITE ERROR 23 RFID ERROR

- 228 -

Page 233: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 229 -

12. CHARACTER CODE TABLE The followings are the character code tables. However, the characters which can be printed are different according to the character type.

12.1 TIMES ROMAN, HELVETICA, LETTER GOTHIC, PRESTIGE ELITE, COURIER, GOTHIC725 BLACK

(Bit map font type: A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J, K, L, N, O, P, Q, R, q)

(1) PC-850

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C ð Ó -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í Ð ß ±2 ” 2 B R b r é Æ ó Ê Ô =

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú Ë Ò ¾4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ È õ ¶5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ Á 1 Õ §6 & 6 F V f v å û ª Â ã Í µ ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù º À Ã Î þ ¸8 ( 8 H X h x ê ÿ ¿ © Ï Þ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö ® Ú ¨A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ Û •B + ; K [ k { ï ø ½ Ù ¹C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ý ³D – = M ] m } ì Ø ¡ ¢ ¦ Ý ²E . > N ^ n ~ Ä × « ¥ Ì ¯

g

F / ? O _ o Å ƒ » ¤ ´

(2) PC-8

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C α ≡1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í β ±2 " 2 B R b r é Æ ó Γ ≥3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú π ≤4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ Σ ⎧5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ σ ⎭6 & 6 F V f v å û ª μ ÷7 ' 7 G W g w ç ù º τ ≈8 ( 8 H X h x ê ÿ ¿ Φ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö Θ •A * : J Z j z è Ü Ω •

B + ; K [ k { ï ¢ ½ δ √C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ∞ n

D – = M ] m } ì ¥ ¡ ∅ 2

E . > N ^ n ~ Ä Pt « ε g

F / ? O _ o Å ∫ » ∩

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 234: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 230 -

(3) PC-852

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C Ó -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü í Ð ß 2 ” 2 B R b r é ó Ô

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú Ë 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö 5 % 5 E U e u Á §6 & 6 F V f v Â Í ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç Î ¸8 ( 8 H X h x °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö Ú ¨A * : J Z j z Ü ¬ •B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | î ý D – = M ] m } Ý E . > N ^ n ~ Ä × «

g

F / ? O _ o » ¤

(4) PC-857

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C º Ó -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í ª ß ±2 " 2 B R b r é Æ ó Ê Ô

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú Ë Ò ¾4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ È õ ¶5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ Á Õ §6 & 6 F V f v å û Â ã Í µ ÷7 ' 7 G W g w ç ù À Ã Î ¸8 ( 8 H X h x ê ¿ © Ï × °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö ® Ú ¨A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ Û •B + ; K [ k { ï ø ½ Ù ¹C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ì ³D – = M ] m } Ø ¡ ¢ ¦ ÿ ²E . > N ^ n ~ Ä « ¥ Ì ¯

g

F / ? O _ o Å » ¤ ´

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 235: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 231 -

(5) PC-851

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ü ±2 ” 2 B R b r é 3 # 3 C S c s â ô 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö 5 % 5 E U e u à §6 & 6 F V f v û 7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù ¸8 ( 8 H X h x ê °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö ¨A * : J Z j z è Ü B + ; K [ k { Ï ½ C , < L \ l | î £ D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ Ä « g

F / ? O _ o »

(6) PC-855

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D – = M ] m } §E . > N ^ n ~ « g

F / ? O _ o » ¤

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 236: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 232 -

(7) PC-1250

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ± Á á 2 ” 2 B R b r  â 3 # 3 C S c s Ó ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u µ 6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ Ö ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ¨ ¸ 9 ) 9 I Y i y © É é A * : J Z j z Ú úB + ; K [ k { « » Ë ë C , < L \ l | ¬ Ü üD – = M ] m } Í Ý í ýE . > N ^ n ~ ® Î î F / ? O _ o ß

(8) PC-1251

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ± 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ 5 % 5 E U e u µ 6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ 7 ' 7 G W g w § · 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y © A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ ® F / ? O _ o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 237: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 233 -

(9) PC-1252

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C À Ð à ð1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ñ2 ” 2 B R b r ¢ ² Â Ò â ò3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ³ Ã Ó ã ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ Æ Ö æ ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ^ ˜ ¨ ¸ È Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y © ¹ É Ù é ùA * : J Z j z ª º Ê Ú ê úB + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ì Ü ì üD – = M ] m } ½ Í Ý í ýE . > N ^ n ~ ® ¾ Î Þ î þF / ? O _ o ¿ Ï ß ï ÿ

(10) PC-1253

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ± 2 " 2 B R b r ² 3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ³ 4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ 5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ 6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ 7 ' 7 G W g w § · 8 ( 8 H X h x ¨ 9 ) 9 I Y i y © A * : J Z j z ª B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ D – = M ] m } ½ E . > N ^ n ~ ® F / ? O _ o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 238: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 234 -

(11) PC-1254

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C À à 1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ñ2 ” 2 B R b r ¢ ² Â Ò â ò3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ³ Ã Ó ã ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ Æ Ö æ ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ^ ˜ ¨ ¸ È Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y © ¹ É Ù é ùA * : J Z j z ª º Ê Ú ê úB + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ì Ü ì üD – = M ] m } ½ Í í ¹E . > N ^ n ~ ® ¾ Î î F / ? O _ o ¿ Ï ß ï ÿ

(12) PC-1257

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ± 2 " 2 B R b r ¢ ² 3 # 3 C S c s £ ³ Ó ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä ä 5 % 5 E U e u µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ Ö ö7 ' 7 G W g w § · × ÷8 ( 8 H X h x Ø ø 9 ) 9 I Y i y © ¹ É é A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ü üD – = M ] m } ¨ ¯ ½ E . > N ^ n ~ ® ¾ F / ? O _ o ¸ Æ æ ß

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 239: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 235 -

(13) LATIN9

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C À Ð à ð1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ñ2 ” 2 B R b r ¢ ² Â Ò â ò3 # 3 C S c s £ ³ Ã Ó ã ó4 $ 4 D T d t C Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¶ Æ Ö æ ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x È Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y © ¹ É Ù é ùA * : J Z j z ª º Ê Ú ê úB + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ Ì Ü ì üD – = M ] m } Í Ý í ýE . > N ^ n ~ ® Î Þ î þF / ? O _ o ¿ Ï ß ï ÿ

(14) Arabic

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ F / ? O _ o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 240: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 236 -

12.2 PRESENTATION (Bit map font type: M)

(1) PC-850, PC-857

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C -1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T 5 % 5 E U E U 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } E . > N ^ N ~ ¥ F / ? O _ O

(2) PC-8

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C 1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T 5 % 5 E U E U 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } ¥ E . > N ^ N ~ F / ? O _ O

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 241: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 237 -

(3) PC-852

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C -1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T 5 % 5 E U E U 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } E . > N ^ N ~ F / ? O _ O

(4) PC-851, PC-855, PC-1250, PC-1251, PC-1257, Arabic

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C 1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T 5 % 5 E U E U 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } E . > N ^ N ~ F / ? O _ O

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 242: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 238 -

(5) PC-1252, PC-1254

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C 1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T 5 % 5 E U E U ¥ 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X ^ ˜ 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } E . > N ^ N ~ F / ? O _ O

(6) PC-1253

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C -1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T 5 % 5 E U E U ¥ 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } E . > N ^ N ~ F / ? O _ O

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 243: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 239 -

(7) LATIN9

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` P C 1 ! 1 A Q A Q 2 " 2 B R B R 3 # 3 C S C S 4 $ 4 D T D T C 5 % 5 E U E U ¥ 6 & 6 F V F V 7 ' 7 G W G W 8 ( 8 H X H X 9 ) 9 I Y I Y A * : J Z J Z B + ; K [ K { C , < L \ L | D – = M ] M } E . > N ^ N ~ F / ? O _ O

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 244: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 240 -

12.3 OCR-A (Bit map font type: S)

(1) PC-850, PC-857

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P -1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X 9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M E . > N ¥ F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p -1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ¥ F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 245: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 241 -

(2) PC-8

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X 9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M ¥ E . > N F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } ¥ E . > N ^ n F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 246: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 242 -

(3) PC-852

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P -1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X 9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M E . > N F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p -1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 247: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 243 -

(4) PC-851, PC-855, PC-1250, PC-1251, PC-1257, Arabic

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X 9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M E . > N F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 248: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 244 -

(5) PC-1252, PC-1254

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P -1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U ¥ 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X ^ ˜

9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M E . > N F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p -1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u ¥ 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x ^ ˜

9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 249: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 245 -

(6) PC-1253

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P -1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U ¥ 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X 9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M E . > N F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p -1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u ¥ 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 250: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 246 -

(7) LATIN9

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 1 1 A Q 2 " 2 B R 3 3 C S 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 E U ¥ 6 6 F V 7 7 G W 8 8 H X

9 9 I Y A J Z B + K C < L D - M E . > N F / O

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P p 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u ¥ 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x

9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D - = M ] m } E . > N ^ n F / ? O o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 251: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 247 -

12.4 OCR-B (Bit map font type: T)

(1) PC-850, PC-857

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 0 -

1 1 A Q 1

2 " 2 B R 2

3 3 C S 3

4 $ 4 D T 4

5 5 E U 5

6 6 F V 6

7 7 G W 7

8 8 H X 8

9 9 I Y 9

A J Z

B + K

C < L

D - M

E . > N ¥

F / O

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p 0 -

1 ! 1 A Q a q 1

2 " 2 B R b r 2

3 # 3 C S c s 3

4 $ 4 D T d t 4

5 % 5 E U e u 5

6 & 6 F V f v 6

7 ' 7 G W g w 7

8 ( 8 H X h x 8

9 ) 9 I Y i y 9

A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k {

C , < L \ l |

D - = M ] m }

E . > N ^ n ~ ¥

F / ? O _ o

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 252: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 248 -

(2) PC-8

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 0

1 1 A Q 1

2 " 2 B R 2

3 3 C S 3

4 $ 4 D T 4

5 5 E U 5

6 6 F V 6

7 7 G W 7

8 8 H X 8

9 9 I Y 9

A J Z

B + K

C < L

D - M ¥

E . > N

F / O

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p 0

1 ! 1 A Q a q 1

2 " 2 B R b r 2

3 # 3 C S c s 3

4 $ 4 D T d t 4

5 % 5 E U e u 5

6 & 6 F V f v 6

7 ' 7 G W g w 7

8 ( 8 H X h x 8

9 ) 9 I Y i y 9

A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k {

C , < L \ l |

D - = M ] m } ¥

E . > N ^ n ~

F / ? O _ o

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 253: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 249 -

(3) PC-852

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 0 -

1 1 A Q 1

2 " 2 B R 2

3 3 C S 3

4 $ 4 D T 4

5 5 E U 5

6 6 F V 6

7 7 G W 7

8 8 H X 8

9 9 I Y 9

A J Z

B + K

C < L

D - M

E . > N

F / O

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p 0 -

1 ! 1 A Q a q 1

2 " 2 B R b r 2

3 # 3 C S c s 3

4 $ 4 D T d t 4

5 % 5 E U e u 5

6 & 6 F V f v 6

7 ' 7 G W g w 7

8 ( 8 H X h x 8

9 ) 9 I Y i y 9

A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k {

C , < L \ l |

D - = M ] m }

E . > N ^ n ~

F / ? O _ o

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 254: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 250 -

(4) PC-851, PC-855, PC-1250, PC-1251, PC-1257, Arabic

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 0

1 1 A Q 1

2 " 2 B R 2

3 3 C S 3

4 $ 4 D T 4

5 5 E U 5

6 6 F V 6

7 7 G W 7

8 8 H X 8

9 9 I Y 9

A J Z

B + K

C < L

D - M

E . > N

F / O

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p 0

1 ! 1 A Q a q 1

2 " 2 B R b r 2

3 # 3 C S c s 3

4 $ 4 D T d t 4

5 % 5 E U e u 5

6 & 6 F V f v 6

7 ' 7 G W g w 7

8 ( 8 H X h x 8

9 ) 9 I Y i y 9

A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k {

C , < L \ l |

D - = M ] m }

E . > N ^ n ~

F / ? O _ o

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 255: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 251 -

(5) PC-1252, PC-1254, LATIN9

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 0

1 1 A Q 1

2 " 2 B R 2

3 3 C S 3

4 $ 4 D T 4

5 5 E U 5 ¥

6 6 F V 6

7 7 G W 7

8 8 H X 8 ˜

9 9 I Y 9

A J Z

B + K

C < L

D - M

E . > N

F / O

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p 0

1 ! 1 A Q a q 1

2 " 2 B R b r 2

3 # 3 C S c s 3

4 $ 4 D T d t 4

5 % 5 E U e u 5 ¥

6 & 6 F V f v 6

7 ' 7 G W g w 7

8 ( 8 H X h x 8 ˜

9 ) 9 I Y i y 9

A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k {

C , < L \ l |

D - = M ] m }

E . > N ^ n ~

F / ? O _ o

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 256: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 252 -

(6) PC-1253

203-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 P 0

1 1 A Q 1

2 " 2 B R 2

3 3 C S 3

4 $ 4 D T 4

5 5 E U 5 ¥

6 6 F V 6

7 7 G W 7

8 8 H X 8

9 9 I Y 9

A J Z

B + K

C < L

D - M

E . > N

F / O

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

300-dpi print head model

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p 0

1 ! 1 A Q a q 1

2 " 2 B R b r 2

3 # 3 C S c s 3

4 $ 4 D T d t 4

5 % 5 E U e u 5 ¥

6 & 6 F V f v 6

7 ' 7 G W g w 7

8 ( 8 H X h x 8

9 ) 9 I Y i y 9

A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k {

C , < L \ l |

D - = M ] m }

E . > N ^ n ~

F / ? O _ o

The size of the numerals of codes 80h ~ 89h are reduced to 80%.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”.

Page 257: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 253 -

12.5 TEC OUTLINE FONT 1 (Outline font type: A, B)

(1) PC-850

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í C ß ±2 ” 2 B R b r é Æ ó

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ õ 5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ §6 & 6 F V f v å û ª ã µ ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù º 8 ( 8 H X h x ê ÿ ¿ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ •B + ; K [ k { ï ø ½ C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ D – = M ] m } ì Ø ¡ ¢ ²E . > N ^ n ~ Ä « ¥

g

F / ? O _ o Å ƒ » ¤

(2) PC-8

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C α ≡1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í C β ±2 " 2 B R b r é Æ ó Γ ≥3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú π ≤4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ Σ ⎧5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ σ ⎭6 & 6 F V f v å û ª μ ÷7 ' 7 G W g w ç ù º τ ≈8 ( 8 H X h x ê ÿ ¿ Φ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö Θ •A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ Ω •

B + ; K [ k { ï ¢ ½ δ √C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ∞ n

D – = M ] m } ì ¥ ¡ ∅ 2

E . > N ^ n ~ Ä Pt « ε g

F / ? O _ o Å ∫ » ∩

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 258: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 254 -

(3) PC-852

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü í C ß 2 ” 2 B R b r é ó

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö 5 % 5 E U e u §6 & 6 F V f v ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç 8 ( 8 H X h x °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö A * : J Z j z Ü ¬ •B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | î D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ Ä «

g

F / ? O _ o » ¤

(4) PC-857

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C º -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í C ª ß ±2 " 2 B R b r é Æ ó 3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ õ 5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ §6 & 6 F V f v å û ã µ ÷7 ' 7 G W g w ç ù 8 ( 8 H X h x ê ¿ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ •

B + ; K [ k { ï ø ½ C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ì D – = M ] m } Ø ¡ ¢ ÿ 2

E . > N ^ n ~ Ä « ¥ g

F / ? O _ o Å » ¤

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 259: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 255 -

(5) PC-851

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ü C ±2 " 2 B R b r é 3 # 3 C S c s â ô 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö 5 % 5 E U e u à §6 & 6 F V f v û 7 ' 7 G W g w ç ù 8 ( 8 H X h x ê °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö A * : J Z j z è Ü

B + ; K [ k { Ï ½ C , < L \ l | î £ D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ Ä « g

F / ? O _ o »

(6) PC-855

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q C 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D – = M ] m } §E . > N ^ n ~ « g

F / ? O _ o » ¤

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 260: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 256 -

(7) PC-1250

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q C á 2 " 2 B R b r â 3 # 3 C S c s ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ Ä ä ô5 % 5 E U e u µ 6 & 6 F V f v Ö ö7 ' 7 G W g w § · Ç ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y É é A * : J Z j z ú

B + ; K [ k { « » ë C , < L \ l | ¬ Ü üD – = M ] m } Í E . > N ^ n ~ Î F / ? O _ o ß

(8) PC-1251

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q C 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ 5 % 5 E U e u µ 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w § · 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ F / ? O _ o

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 261: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 257 -

(9) PC-1252

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C à 1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ C Ñ á ñ2 " 2 B R b r ¢ ² â ò3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ã ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ Ä ä ô5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å å õ6 & 6 F V f v Æ Ö æ ö7 ' 7 G W g w § · Ç ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ^ ˜ Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y é ùA * : J Z j z ª ê ú

B + ; K [ k { « » ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ü ì üD – = M ] m } ½ Í E . > N ^ n ~ î F / ? O _ o ¿ ß ï ÿ

(10) PC-1253

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q C 2 " 2 B R b r ² 3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ 4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ 5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w § · 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z ª

B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ D – = M ] m } ½ E . > N ^ n ~ F / ? O _ o

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 262: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 258 -

(11) PC-1254

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C à 1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ C Ñ á ñ2 " 2 B R b r ¢ ² â ò3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ã ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ Ä ä ô5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å å õ6 & 6 F V f v Æ Ö æ ö7 ' 7 G W g w § · Ç ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ^ ˜ Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y É é ùA * : J Z j z ª º ê ú

B + ; K [ k { « » ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ü ì üD – = M ] m } ½ Í E . > N ^ n ~ î F / ? O _ o ¿ ß Ï ÿ

(12) PC-1257

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q C 2 " 2 B R b r ¢ ² 3 # 3 C S c s £ ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ Ä ä 5 % 5 E U e u µ Å å õ6 & 6 F V f v Ö ö7 ' 7 G W g w § · ÷8 ( 8 H X h x Ø ø 9 ) 9 I Y i y É é A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ü üD – = M ] m } ½ E . > N ^ n ~ F / ? O _ o Æ æ ß

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 263: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 259 -

(13) LATIN9

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C à 1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ C Ñ á ñ2 " 2 B R b r ¢ ² â ò3 # 3 C S c s £ ã ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ Ä ä ô5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å å õ6 & 6 F V f v Æ Ö æ ö7 ' 7 G W g w § · Ç ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y É é ùA * : J Z j z ª º ê ú

B + ; K [ k { « » ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ Ü ì üD – = M ] m } Í E . > N ^ n ~ î F / ? O _ o ¿ ß Ï ÿ

(14) Arabic

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q C 2 " 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ' 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z

B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ F / ? O _ o

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 264: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 260 -

12.6 PRICE FONT 1, 2, 3 (Outline font type: E, F, G)

(1) All types of character codes

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 -1 1 2 2 3 3 4 $ 4 5 % 5 6 6 7 7 8 8 9 9 A

B C , ¥ D – E . ~ F /

Page 265: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 261 -

12.7 TEC OUTLINE FONT 2, 3, GOTHIC725 BLACK (Outline font type: H, I, J)

(1) PC-850

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C ð Ó -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í Ð ß ±2 ” 2 B R b r é Æ ó Ê Ô =

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú Ë Ò ¾4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ È õ ¶5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ Á Ì Õ §6 & 6 F V f v å û ª Â ã Í µ ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù º À Ã Î þ ¸8 ( 8 H X h x ê ÿ ¿ © Ï Þ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö ® Ú ¨A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ Û •B + ; K [ k { ï ø ½ Ù ¹C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ý ³D – = M ] m } ì Ø ¡ ¢ ¦ Ý ²E . > N ˆ n ~ Ä × « ¥ Ì ¯

g

F / ? O _ o Å ƒ » ¤ ´

(2) PC-8

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í ±2 ” 2 B R b r é Æ ó

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ 5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ 6 & 6 F V f v å û ª µ ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù º 8 ( 8 H X h x ê ÿ ¿ °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ •B + ; K [ k { ï ¢ ½ C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ D – = M ] m } ì ¥ ¡ ²E . > N ˆ n ~ Ä «

g

F / ? O _ o Å ƒ »

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 266: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 262 -

¨

Š

¸¸

Š

ŠŠ

ŠŠ

ŠŠ

ŠŠŠ

Š

Š

Š

¨

¨

å

å

ŠŠ

Š

Š

Š

´

‘‘

‘‘

´´

´

´

´

´

´

¸

´́´

¸¸¸

´´´

´

´´

´́

´́

´́´́

ŠŠ

(3) PC-852

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C d Ó -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü L í Ð ß 2 ” 2 B R b r é Í ó D Ô

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú Ë N 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö A d n 5 % 5 E U e u u L a A N n §6 & 6 F V f v c I Z Â A Í Š ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç S z E a Î š ¸8 ( 8 H X h x l s E S e R °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö e U ¨A * : J Z j z O Ü ¬ r •B + ; K [ k { o T z U uC , < L \ l | î t C y RD – = M ] m } Z L s Z T Y rE . > N ˆ n ~ Ä × « z U t g

F / ? O _ o C c » ¤

(4) PC-857

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç É á C º Ó -1 ! 1 A Q a q ü æ í ª ß ±2 ” 2 B R b r é Æ ó Ê Ô

3 # 3 C S c s â ô ú Ë Ò ¾4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö ñ È õ ¶5 % 5 E U e u à ò Ñ Á Õ §6 & 6 F V f v å û G Â ã Í µ ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù g À Ã Î ¸8 ( 8 H X h x ê I ¿ © Ï × °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö ® Ú ¨A * : J Z j z è Ü ¬ Û •B + ; K [ k { ï ø ½ Ù ¹C , < L \ l | î £ ¼ ì ³D – = M ] m } ¹ Ø ¡ ¢ ¦ ÿ ²E . > N ˆ n ~ Ä S « ¥ Ì ¯

g

F / ? O _ o Å s » ¤ ´

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 267: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 263 -

(5) PC-851

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p Ç C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ü ±2 ” 2 B R b r é

3 # 3 C S c s â ô 4 $ 4 D T d t ä ö 5 % 5 E U e u à §6 & 6 F V f v û 7 ’ 7 G W g w ç ù ¸8 ( 8 H X h x ê °9 ) 9 I Y i y ë Ö ¨A * : J Z j z è Ü B + ; K [ k { ï ½ C , < L \ l | î £ D – = M ] m } E . > N ˆ n ~ Ä « g

F / ? O _ o »

(6) PC-855

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 ” 2 B R b r

3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ’ 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D – = M ] m } §E . > N ˆ n ~ «

g

F / ? O _ o » ¤

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 268: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 264 -

Š

Š

Š Š

¨

å

Š

´ ´´

´ ´

¸¸¸

¸¸

´

´

´ ´

´ ´

´́

´́

Š

´́

ŠŠ Š

Š Š

Š ŠŠ Š

Š Š ŠŠ¨

‘‘ ´́ ´́

å

(7) PC-1250

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C R Ð r ð1 ! 1 A Q a q ± Á N á n2 ” 2 B R b r N â n3 # 3 C S c s L l Ó ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u A µ L O Í o6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ C Ö c ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ¨ ¸ C R c r9 ) 9 I Y i y a É U é uA * : J Z j z S s S s E Ú e úB + ; K [ k { S s « » Ë U ë uC , < L \ l | T t ¬ L E Ü e üD – = M ] m } - Í Ý í ýE . > N ^ n ~ Z z ® I Î T î tF / ? O _ o Z Z z z D ß

(8) PC-1251

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ± 2 ” 2 B R b r

3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ 5 % 5 E U e u µ 6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ 7 ’ 7 G W g w § · 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ D – = M ] m } - E . > N ^ n ~ ® F / ? O _ o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 269: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 265 -

Š Š

Š Š

(9) PC-1252

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C Ð à ð1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ñ2 ” 2 B R b r ² Ò â ò3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ³ Ó ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ Æ Ö æ ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ˆ ˜ ¨ ¸ È Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y ¹ É Ù é ùA * : J Z j z S s ª º Ê Ú ê úB + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ì Ü ì üD – = M ] m } - ½ Í Ý í ýE . > N ^ n ~ Z z ® Î î F / ? O _ o ¿ Ï ß ï ÿ

(10) PC-1253

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q ± 2 ” 2 B R b r ²

3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ³ 4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ 5 % 5 E U e u µ 6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ 7 ’ 7 G W g w § · 8 ( 8 H X h x ¨ 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z ª B + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ D – = M ] m } - ½ E . > N ^ n ~ ® F / ? O _ o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 270: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 266 -

Š Š

¸¸

¨

´ ´

´

´ ´ ´´

´

Š ‘‘

‘ ‘

‘Š

Š

Š Š

¨Š Š

(11) PC-1254

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C à 1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ñ2 ” 2 B R b r ² Ò â ò3 # 3 C S c s ƒ £ ³ Ó ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä Ô ä ô5 % 5 E U e u µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ Æ Ö æ ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷8 ( 8 H X h x ˆ ˜ ¨ ¸ È Ø è ø9 ) 9 I Y i y ¹ É Ù é ùA * : J Z j z S s ª º Ê Ú ê úB + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë ûC , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ì Ü ì üD – = M ] m } - ½ Í í ¹E . > N ^ n ~ ® Î S î sF / ? O _ o - ¿ Ï ß ï ÿ

(12) PC-1257

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C A S a s1 ! 1 A Q a q ± N n2 ” 2 B R b r ² 3 # 3 C S c s £ ³ C Ó c ó4 $ 4 D T d t ¤ ´ Ä ä 5 % 5 E U e u µ Å Õ å õ6 & 6 F V f v ¦ ¶ E Ö e ö7 ’ 7 G W g w § · × ÷8 ( 8 H X h x Ø ø C c 9 ) 9 I Y i y ¹ É L é lA * : J Z j z Z S z sB + ; K [ k { « » C , < L \ l | ¬ ¼ Ü üD – = M ] m } ¨ ¯ - ½ Z zE . > N ^ n ~ ® Z zF / ? O _ o ¸ Æ æ ß

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 271: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 267 -

Š

Š

Š Š

(13) LATIN9

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C Ð à ñ1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ò2 ” 2 B R b r ² Ò â ó3 # 3 C S c s £ ³ Ó ô4 $ 4 D T d t ð Z Ä Ô ä õ5 % 5 E U e u µ Å Õ å ö6 & 6 F V f v S ¾ Æ Ö æ ÷7 ’ 7 G W g w § Ç × ç ø8 ( 8 H X h x s z È Ø è ù9 ) 9 I Y i y ¹ É Ù é úA * : J Z j z ª º Ê Ú ê ûB + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë üC , < L \ l | ¬ Ì Ü ì ýD – = M ] m } - Í Ý í E . > N ^ n ~ ® Î î ÿF / ? O _ o ¿ Ï ß ï

(14) Arabic

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 0 @ P ` p C 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 ” 2 B R b r 3 # 3 C S c s 4 $ 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ’ 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K [ k { C , < L \ l | D – = M ] m } E . > N ^ n ~ F / ? O _ o

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

When Japanese message is selected in the system mode, code 5CH indicates “¥”. The Euro code (B0H) can be changed in the parameter setting in the system mode.

Page 272: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

12.8 TrueType FONT

(1) PC-850

(2) PC-8

- 268 -

Page 273: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(3) PC-852

(4) PC-857

- 269 -

Page 274: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(5) PC-851

(6) PC-855

- 270 -

Page 275: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(7) PC-1250

(8) PC-1251

- 271 -

Page 276: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(9) PC-1252

(10) PC-1253

- 272 -

Page 277: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(11) PC-1254

(12) PC-1257

- 273 -

Page 278: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

(13) LATIN9

Š

Š

Š Š

2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F

0 0 @ P ` p ° À Ð à ð

1 ! 1 A Q a q ¡ ± Á Ñ á ñ

2 " 2 B R b r ¢ ² Â Ò â ò

3 # 3 C S c s £ ³ Ã Ó ã ó

4 $ 4 D T d t C Z Ä Ô ä ô

5 % 5 E U e u ¥ µ Å Õ å õ

6 & 6 F V f v S ¶ Æ Ö æ ö

7 ' 7 G W g w § · Ç × ç ÷

8 ( 8 H X h x s z È Ø è ø

9 ) 9 I Y i y © ¹ É Ù é ù

A * : J Z j z ª º Ê Ú ê ú

B + ; K [ k { « » Ë Û ë û

C , < L \ l | ¬ Œ Ì Ü ì ü

D – = M ] m } - œ Í Ý í ý

E . > N ^ n ~ ® Ÿ Î Þ î þ

F / ? O _ o ¯ ¿ Ï ß ï ÿ

(14) Arabic

- 274 -

Page 279: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 275 -

13. BAR CODE TABLE (1) WPC (JAN, EAN, UPC) (2) CODE39 (Standard)

ITF, MSI, UCC/EAN128, Industrial 2 of 5 RSS-14/RSS-14 Stacked RSS-14 Stacked Omnidirectional RSS-Limited

2 3 4 5 6 7 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 0 0 SP 0 P 1 1 1 1 A Q 2 2 2 2 B R 3 3 3 3 C S 4 4 4 $ 4 D T 5 5 5 % 5 E U 6 6 6 6 F V 7 7 7 7 G W 8 8 8 8 H X 9 9 9 9 I Y A A * J Z B B + K C C L D D – M E E • N F F / O

(3) CODE39 (Full ASCII)

[Transfer code] [Drawing code]

2 3 4 5 6 7 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 SP 0 @ P ` p 0 SP 0 %V P %W +P1 ! 1 A Q a q 1 /A 1 A Q +A +Q2 " 2 B R b r 2 /B 2 B R +B +R3 # 3 C S c s 3 /C 3 C S +C +S4 $ 4 D T d t 4 /D 4 D T +D +T5 % 5 E U e u 5 /E 5 E U +E +U6 & 6 F V f v 6 /F 6 F V +F +V7 ' 7 G W g w 7 /G 7 G W +G +W8 ( 8 H X h x 8 /H 8 H X +H +X9 ) 9 I Y i y 9 /I 9 I Y +I +YA * : J Z j z A /J /Z J Z +J +ZB + ; K [ k { B /K %F K %K +K %PC , < L \ l | C /L %G L %L +L %QD – = M ] m } D – %H M %M +M %RE . > N ^ n ~ E . %I N %N +N %SF / ? O _ o F /O %J O %O +O %T

Page 280: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 276 -

(4) NW-7

2 3 4 5 6 7

0 SP 0

1 1 A a

2 2 B b

3 3 C c

4 $ 4 D d t

5 5 e

6 6

7 7

8 8

9 9

A * :

B +

C

D –

E • n

F /

(5) CODE93

[Transfer code] [Drawing code]

2 3 4 5 6 7 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 SP 0 @ P ` p 0 SP 0 %V P %W +P1 ! 1 A Q a q 1 /A 1 A Q +A +Q2 " 2 B R b r 2 /B 2 B R +B +R3 # 3 C S c s 3 /C 3 C S +C +S4 $ 4 D T d t 4 /D 4 D T +D +T5 % 5 E U e u 5 /E 5 E U +E +U6 & 6 F V f v 6 /F 6 F V +F +V7 ' 7 G W g w 7 /G 7 G W +G +W8 ( 8 H X h x 8 /H 8 H X +H +X9 ) 9 I Y i y 9 /I 9 I Y +I +YA * : J Z j z A /J /Z J Z +J +ZB + ; K [ k { B + %F K %K +K %PC , < L \ l | C /L %G L %L +L %QD – = M ] m } D – %H M %M +M %RE . > N ^ n ~ E . %I N %N +N %SF / ? O _ o F / %J O %O +O %T

Page 281: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 277 -

(6) CODE128

[Transfer code]

– – 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 " 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ' 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS – = M ] m } E SO RS . > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o

How to transmit control code data:

NUL (00H) → >@ (3EH, 40H) SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → > ^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to transmit special codes:

Value 30 (Character >) → >0 95 → >1 96 → >2 97 → >3 98 → >4 99 → >5 100 → >6 101 → >7 102 → >8

Designation of start code:

START (CODE A) → >7 START (CODE B) → >6 START (CODE C) → >5

[Drawing code] Value Code Table

Page 282: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 278 -

Value Code Table

VALUE CODE A

CODE B

CODE C

VALUE CODE A

CODE B

CODE C

VALUE CODE A

CODE B

CODE C

0 SP SP 00 36 D D 36 72 BS h 72 1 ! ! 01 37 E E 37 73 HT i 73 2 " " 02 38 F F 38 74 LF j 74 3 # # 03 39 G G 39 75 VT k 75 4 $ $ 04 40 H H 40 76 FF l 76 5 % % 05 41 I I 41 77 CR m 77 6 & & 06 42 J J 42 78 SO n 78 7 ' ' 07 43 K K 43 79 SI o 79 8 ( ( 08 44 L L 44 80 DLE p 80 9 ) ) 09 45 M M 45 81 DC1 q 81 10 * * 10 46 N N 46 82 DC2 r 82 11 + + 11 47 O O 47 83 DC3 s 83 12 , , 12 48 P P 48 84 DC4 t 84 13 – – 13 49 Q Q 49 85 NAK u 85 14 . . 14 50 R R 50 86 SYN v 86 15 / / 15 51 S S 51 87 ETB w 87 16 0 0 16 52 T T 52 88 CAN x 88 17 1 1 17 53 U U 53 89 EM y 89 18 2 2 18 54 V V 54 90 SUB z 90 19 3 3 19 55 W W 55 91 ESC { 91 20 4 4 20 56 X X 56 92 FS ¦ 92 21 5 5 21 57 Y Y 57 93 GS } 93 22 6 6 22 58 Z Z 58 94 RS ~ 94 23 7 7 23 59 [ [ 59 95 US DEL 95 24 8 8 24 60 \ \ 60 96 FNC3 FNC3 96 25 9 9 25 61 ] ] 61 97 FNC2 FNC2 97 26 : : 26 62 ^ ^ 62 98 SHIFT SHIFT 98 27 ; ; 27 63 _ _ 63 99 CODE C CODE C 99 28 < < 28 64 NUL ` 64 100 CODE B FNC4 CODE B

29 = = 29 65 SOH a 65 101 FNC4 CODE A CODE A

30 > > 30 66 STX b 66 102 FNC1 FNC1 FNC131 ? ? 31 67 ETX c 67 32 @ @ 32 68 EOT d 68 103 START CODE A 33 A A 33 69 ENQ e 69 104 START CODE B 34 B B 34 70 ACK f 70 105 START CODE C 35 C C 35 71 BEL g 71

Page 283: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 279 -

(7) Data Matrix

The code to be used is designated using the format ID.

Format ID Code Details 1 Numerics 0 to 9 space 2 Letters A to Z space 3 Alphanumerics, symbols 0 to 9 A to Z space . , - / 4 Alphanumerics 0 to 9 A to Z space 5 ASCII (7-bit) 00H to 7FH 6 ISO (8-bit) 00H to FFH (Kanji)

[Transfer Code]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS – = M ] m } E SO RS . > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o

How to send control code data: NUL (00H) → >@ (3EH, 40H)

SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → >^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to send a special code:

> (3EH) → >0 (3EH, 30H)

How to send a Kanji code: Shift JIS

JIS hexadecimal (For details, refer to the section for the Bar Code Data Command.)

Page 284: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 280 -

(8) PDF417

The following modes are automatically selected according to the code used.

Mode Code Details EXC mode Alphanumerics, symbol 0 to 9 A to Z a to z space ! ”

# $ % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; < = > ? @ [ \ ] ^ _ ` { | } ~ CR HT

Binary/ASCII Plus mode

Binary International Character Set

00H to FFH (Kanji)

Numeric Compaction mode

Numerics 0 to 9

[Transfer Code]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS – = M ] m } E SO RS . > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o

How to send control code data:

NUL (00H) → >@ (3EH, 40H) SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → >^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to send a special code:

> (3EH) → >0 (3EH, 30H)

How to send a Kanji code:

Shift JIS JIS hexadecimal (For details, refer to the section for the Bar Code Data Command.)

Page 285: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 281 -

(9) MicroPDF417

The following modes are automatically selected according to the code used.

Mode Details Upper case letters, space

A to Z, space

Binary International Character Set

00H to FFH (Kanji)

Numerics 0 to 9

[Transfer Code]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS – = M ] m } E SO RS . > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o

How to send control code data:

NUL (00H) → >@ (3EH, 40H) SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → >^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to send a special code:

> (3EH) → >0 (3EH, 30H)

How to send a Kanji code:

Shift JIS JIS hexadecimal (For details, refer to the section for the Bar Code Data Command.)

Page 286: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 282 -

(10) QR code

When manual mode is selected in the Format Command

Numeric mode, alphanumeric and symbol mode, Kanji mode

Mode selection Data to be printed

Binary mode

Mode selection No. of data strings (4 digits)

Data to be printed

Mixed mode

Data “,” (comma) Data “,” (comma) Data

The QR code can handle all codes including alphanumerics, symbols, and Kanji. However, since the data compression rate varies according to codes, the code to be used should be designated by selecting the mode.

Mode Code Details N Numerals 0 to 9 A Alphanumerics, symbols A to Z 0 to 9 space

$ % * + - . / : B Binary (8-bit) 00H to FFH K Kanji Shift JIS, JIS hexadecimal

If mixed mode is selected, up to 200 modes can be selected in a QR code.

When the automatic mode is selected in the Format Command for a QR code:

Data to be printed

[Transfer code for QR code]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS - = M ] m } E SO RS • > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o DEL

* The shaded parts are Japanese. They are omitted here.

Page 287: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 283 -

How to send control code data:

NUL (00H) → >@ (3EH, 40H) SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → >^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to send a special code:

> (3EH) → >0 (3EH, 30H)

How to send a Kanji code:

Shift JIS JIS hexadecimal (For details, refer to the section for the Bar Code Data Command.)

Examples of data designation for QR code

Alphanumeric mode: ABC123

A A B C 1 2 3

Data to be printed Designation of mode

Binary mode: 01H, 03H, 05H

B 0 0 0 6 > A > C > E

Data to be printed No. of data strings Designation of mode

Mixed mode

Numeric mode : 123456 Kanji mode : Kanji data Binary mode : a i u e o Alphanumeric and symbol mode : ABC

N 1 2 3 4 5 6, K Kanji data, B 0 0 1 0 a i u e o , A A B C

Designation of mode

Automatic mode

When the same data as above is designated in automatic mode: 1 2 3 4 5 6 Kanji data a i u e o A B C Data to be printed

Data to be printed

Data to be printed No. of data strings

Data to be printed

Data to be printed

Page 288: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 284 -

(11) Postal code

Customer bar code POSTNET

2 3 4 5 6 7 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 0 P 0 0 1 1 A Q 1 1 2 2 B R 2 2 3 3 C S 3 3 4 4 D T 4 4 5 5 E U 5 5 6 6 F V 6 6 7 7 G W 7 7 8 8 H X 8 8 9 9 I Y 9 9 A J Z A B K B C L C D – M D E N E F O F

RM4SCC KIX CODE

2 3 4 5 6 7 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 0 P 0 0 P p 1 1 A Q 1 1 A Q a q 2 2 B R 2 2 B R b r 3 3 C S 3 3 C S c s 4 4 D T 4 4 D T d t 5 5 E U 5 5 E U e u 6 6 F V 6 6 F V f v 7 7 G W 7 7 G W g w8 ( 8 H X 8 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y 9 9 I Y i y A J Z A J Z j z B K B K k C L C L l D M D M m E N E N n F O F O o

* “(” or “)” can be designated only as a start/stop code.

These should not be entered in data. If these are entered between data, no bar code is drawn.

Page 289: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 285 -

(12) MaxiCode

Symbol Character Value

Code Set A Code Set B Code Set C Code Set D Code Set E

Decimal Binary Character Decimal Character Decimal Character Decimal Character Decimal Character Decimal0 000000 CR 13 ‘ 96 À 192 à 224 NUL 0 1 000001 A 65 a 97 Á 193 á 225 SOH 1 2 000010 B 66 b 98 Â 194 â 226 STX 2 3 000011 C 67 c 99 Ã 195 ã 227 ETX 3 4 000100 D 68 d 100 Ä 196 ä 228 EOT 4 5 000101 E 69 e 101 Å 197 å 229 ENQ 5 6 000110 F 70 f 102 Æ 198 æ 230 ACK 6 7 000111 G 71 g 103 Ç 199 ç 231 BEL 7 8 001000 H 72 h 104 È 200 è 232 BS 8 9 001001 I 73 i 105 É 201 é 233 HT 9

10 001010 J 74 j 106 Ê 202 ê 234 LF 10 11 001011 K 75 k 107 Ë 203 ë 235 VT 11 12 001100 L 76 l 108 Ì 204 ì 236 FF 12 13 001101 M 77 m 109 Í 205 í 237 CR 13 14 001110 N 78 n 110 Î 206 î 238 SO 14 15 001111 O 79 o 111 Ï 207 ï 239 SI 15 16 010000 P 80 p 112 Ð 208 ð 240 DLE 16 17 010001 Q 81 q 113 Ñ 209 ñ 241 DC1 17 18 010010 R 82 r 114 Ò 210 ò 242 DC2 18 19 010011 S 83 s 115 Ó 211 ó 243 DC3 19 20 010100 T 84 t 116 Ô 212 ô 244 DC4 20 21 010101 U 85 u 117 Õ 213 õ 245 NAK 21 22 010110 V 86 v 118 Ö 214 ö 246 SYN 22 23 010111 W 87 w 119 × 215 ÷ 247 ETB 23 24 011000 X 88 x 120 Ø 216 ø 248 CAN 24 25 011001 Y 89 y 121 Ù 217 ù 249 EM 25 26 011010 Z 90 z 122 Ú 218 ú 250 SUB 26 27 011011 [EC] [EC] [EC] [EC] [EC] 28 011100 FS 28 FS 28 FS 28 FS 28 [Pad] 29 011101 GS 29 GS 29 GS 29 GS 29 [Pad] 30 011110 RS 30 RS 30 RS 30 RS 30 ESC 27 31 011111 [NS] [NS] [NS] [NS] [NS] 32 100000 Space 32 ( 123 Û 219 û 251 FS 28 33 100001 [Pad] [Pad] Ü 220 ü 252 GS 29 34 100010 “ 34 ) 125 Ý 221 ý 253 RS 30 35 100011 # 35 ~ 126 Þ 222 þ 254 US 31 36 100100 $ 36 DEL 127 ß 223 ÿ 255 {C159} 159 37 100101 % 37 ; 59 ª 170 ¡ 161 NBSP 160 38 100110 & 38 < 60 ¬ 172 ¨ 168 ¢ 162 39 100111 ‘ 39 = 61 ± 177 « 171 £ 163 40 101000 ( 40 > 62 ² 178 ¯ 175 ¤ 164 41 101001 ) 41 ? 63 ³ 179 ° 176 ¥ 165 42 101010 ” 42 [ 91 181 ' 180 166 43 101011 + 43 \ 92 ¹ 185 • 183 § 167 44 101100 , 44 ] 93 º 186 184 © 169 45 101101 - 45 ^ 94 ¼ 188 » 187 SHY 173 46 101110 . 46 _ 95 ½ 189 ¿ 191 ® 174 47 101111 / 47 Space 32 ¾ 190 {C138} 138 ¶ 182 48 110000 0 48 , 44 {C128} 128 {C139} 139 {C149} 149 49 110001 1 49 . 46 {C129} 129 {C140} 140 {C150} 150 50 110010 2 50 / 47 {C130} 130 {C141} 141 {C151} 151 51 110011 3 51 : 58 {C131} 131 {C142} 142 {C152} 152 52 110100 4 52 @ 64 {C132} 132 {C143} 143 {C153} 153 53 110101 5 53 ! 33 {C133} 133 {C144} 144 {C154} 154 54 110110 6 54 | 124 {C134} 134 {C145} 145 {C155} 155 55 110111 7 55 [Pad] {C135} 135 {C146} 146 {C156} 156 56 111000 8 56 [2 Shift A] {C136} 136 {C147} 147 {C157} 157 57 111001 9 57 [3 Shift A] {C137} 137 {C148} 148 {C158} 158 58 111010 : 58 [Pad] [Latch A] [Latch A] [Latch A] 59 111011 [Shift B] [Shift A] Space 32 Space 32 Space 32 60 111100 [Shift C] [Shift C] [Lock In C] [Shift C] [Shift C] 61 111101 [Shift D] [Shift D] [Shift D] [Lock In D] [Shift D] 62 111110 [Shift E] [Shift E] [Shift E] [Shift E] [Lock In E] 63 111111 [Latch B] [Latch A] [Latch B] [Latch B] [Latch B]

Page 290: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 286 -

How to send control code data:

SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → >^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to send a special code:

> (3EH) → >0 (3EH, 30H)

How to send a Kanji code:

Shift JIS JIS hexadecimal (For details, refer to the section for the Bar Code Data Command.)

NOTE: “NUL” code in the table cannot be used, however, it can be designated. If it is designated, data following “NUL” code is not printed.

When the MaxiCode specification setting is set to “TYPE2: Special specification” in the system mode:

[Transfer code for MaxiCode]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F 0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y

A LF (Note1) SUB * : J Z j z

B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS - = M ] m } E SO RS • > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o DEL (Note2)

The all codes (00H to FFH) can be used. In the following cases, however, the codes will become special codes. For the transfer method, refer to the following.

(Note 1) In case of LF (0AH) data:

LF (0AH) → J (FFH, 4AH)

(Note 2) In case of (FFH) data:

(FFH) → (FFH, FFH)

ESC (1BH) and NUL (00H) can be used as they are.

Page 291: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 287 -

(13) CP code

[Transfer Code]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 NUL DLE SP 0 @ P ` p 1 SOH DC1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 STX DC2 ” 2 B R b r 3 ETX DC3 # 3 C S c s 4 EOT DC4 $ 4 D T d t 5 ENQ NAK % 5 E U e u 6 ACK SYN & 6 F V f v 7 BEL ETB ’ 7 G W g w 8 BS CAN ( 8 H X h x 9 HT EM ) 9 I Y i y A LF SUB * : J Z j z B VT ESC + ; K [ k { C FF FS , < L \ l | D CR GS – = M ] m } E SO RS . > N ^ n ~ F SI US / ? O _ o

How to send control code data:

NUL (00H) → >@ (3EH, 40H) SOH (01H) → >A (3EH, 41H) STX (02H) → >B (3EH, 42H) to GS (1DH) → >] (3EH, 5DH) RS (1EH) → >^ (3EH, 5EH) US (1FH) → >_ (3EH, 5FH)

How to send a special code:

> (3EH) → >0 (3EH, 30H)

How to send a Kanji code:

Shift JIS JIS hexadecimal (For details, refer to the section for the Bar Code Data Command.)

Page 292: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

- 288 -

(14) RSS Expanded

[Transfer Code]

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F0 SP 0 P p 1 ! 1 A Q a q 2 ” 2 B R b r 3 FNC1 3 C S c s 4 4 D T d t 5 % 5 E U e u 6 & 6 F V f v 7 ’ 7 G W g w 8 ( 8 H X h x 9 ) 9 I Y i y A * : J Z j z B + ; K k C , < L l D – = M m E . > N n F / ? O _ o

Page 293: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

14. DRAWING OF BAR CODE DATA : Field to be incremented/decremented (The absence of a solid line invalidates incrementing/decrementing.)

: Field subject to printing numerals under bars.

Type of Bar Code: JAN8, EAN8

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

8 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

Other than 8 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

8 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing Data

Other than 8 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

7 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 7 digits Not to be drawn

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

C/DD7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

- 289 -

Page 294: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: JAN13, EAN13

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

13 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 D13D12D11D10D9

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

13 digits

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Input Data

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 D13D12D11D10D9

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

12 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 12 digits Not to be drawn

(4) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

11 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 4 digits.

Other than 11 digits Not to be drawn

(5) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

11 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 5 digits.

Other than 11 digits Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D9 D10 D11

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D12D9 D10 D11

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9

D8P/CDD7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9

D7P/CDD6D5D4D3D2 C/D D11D10D9D8

- 290 -

Page 295: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: UPC-A

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

12 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing Data

Other than 12 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9

Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D 12 digits

Drawing

Data

Other than 12 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

11 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 11 digits Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9

C/DD8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9

(4) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

10 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 4 digits.

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

C/D D6D5D4D3D2D1 D7 D8P/CD D10D9

Other than 10 digits Not to be drawn

(5) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

10 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 5 digits.

Other than 10 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

C/D D6D5D4D3D2D1 D7 D8P/CD D10D9

Not to be drawn

- 291 -

Page 296: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: UPC-E

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D 7 digits

Drawing

Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10

Other than 7 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

7 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10

Other than 7 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

6 digits

Input Data

Calculate and reflect modulus 10 in the bar code.

Drawing

Data

D6D5D4D3D2D1

C/DD6D5D4D3D2D10

Other than 6 digits Not to be drawn

- 292 -

Page 297: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: JAN8 + 2 digits, EAN8 + 2 digits

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D 10 digits

Drawing

Data

Other than 10 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

10 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

D9 D10D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8

Drawing

Data

Other than 10 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

Input Data

9 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 9 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

C/D D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

Not to be drawn

- 293 -

Page 298: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: JAN8 + 5 digits, EAN8 + 5 digits

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D 13 digits

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D11 D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D13D12D11

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D 13 digits

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D11 D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D13D12D11

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

12 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 12 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9 D11D10 D12

C/D D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9 D10 D11 D12

Not to be drawn

- 294 -

Page 299: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: JAN13 + 2 digits, EAN13 + 2 digits

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

15 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

Other than 15 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

15 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

Other than 15 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

14 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 14 digits Not to be drawn

(4) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

13 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 4 digits.

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

(5) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

13 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 5 digits.

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

D8P/CDD7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9 D13D12

D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14

D8P/CD D7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9 D13D12

D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D9 D10 D11

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D12D11D10D9

D14

D13 D14

- 295 -

Page 300: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: JAN13 + 5 digits, EAN13 + 5 digits

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

18 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14 D16 D18D17

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14 D18D17D16

Other than 18 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

18 digits

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Input Data

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14 D16 D18D17

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 D13D12D11D10D9 D15D14 D18D17D16

Other than 18 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

17 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 17 digits Not to be drawn

(4) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

16 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 4 digits.

Other than 16 digits Not to be drawn

(5) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

16 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 5 digits.

Other than 16 digits Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D13D12D11D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D12D11D10D9

D14

D14D13

D15 D16 D17

D15 D16 D17

D8P/CDD7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D11D10D9 D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 D16

D14 D15 D16

P/CD D8D7D6D5D4D3D2 C/D D11D10D9 D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 D16

D14 D15 D16

- 296 -

Page 301: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: UPC-A + 2 digits

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

14 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

Other than 14 digits Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13

(2) Modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

14 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing Data

Other than 14 digits Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

13 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 13 digits Not to be drawn

(4) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits No. of Input Digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9 D13D12

C/DD8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9 D13D12

Input Data

12 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 4 digits.

Other than 12 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D12D11

C/D D6D5D4D3D2D1 D7 D8P/CD D10D9 D12D11

Not to be drawn

(5) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

12 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 5 digits.

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9 D12

C/D D6D5D4D3D2D1 D7 D8P/CD D10D9 D11 D12

Other than 12 digits Not to be drawn

- 297 -

Page 302: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: UPC-A + 5 digits

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

17 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13 D15 D17D16

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13 D17D16D15

Other than 17 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

17 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

Other than 17 digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13 D15 D17D16

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D12D11D10D9 D14D13 D17D16D15

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

16 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

Other than 16 digits Not to be drawn

(4) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 4 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

15 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 4 digits.

Other than 15 digits Not to be drawn

(5) Auto affix of modulus 10 + Price C/D 5 digits No. of Input Digits

Input Data

15 digits

Drawing Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix price C/D 5 digits.

Other than 15 digits Not to be drawn

C/DD8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D11D10D9 D13D12

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 D16

D14 D15 D16

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D12D11 D13 D15D14

C/D D6D5D4D3D2D1 D7 D8P/CD D10D9 D12D11 D15D14D13

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9 D13D12D11 D15D14

C/D D6D5D4D3D2D1 D7 D8P/CD D10D9 D11 D12 D13 D15D14

- 298 -

Page 303: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: UPC-E + 2 digits

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

9 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing

Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10 D9D8

Other than 9 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

9 digits

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Input Data

Drawing

Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10 D9D8

Other than 9 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

8 digits

Drawing Data

Other than 8 digits Not to be drawn

Calculate and reflect modulus 10 C/D in the bar code.

D6D5D4D1 D2 D3 D7

C/D

D8

D6D5D4D3D2D10 D7 D8

- 299 -

Page 304: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: UPC-E + 5 digits

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

12 digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Drawing Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8 D10 D12D11

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10 D9D8 D11D10 D12

Other than 12 digits Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D 12 digits

Drawing

Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10 D9D8 D11D10 D12

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8 D10 D12D11

Other than 12 digits Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

11 digits Drawing

Data

Other than 11 digits Not to be drawn

Calculate and reflect modulus 10 C/D in the bar code. D6D5D4D1 D2 D3 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11

C/DD6D5D4D10 D2 D3 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11

- 300 -

Page 305: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: MSI

(1) No affix No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Not recognized as a check digit. Max. 15 digits

Drawing

Data

16 digits or more

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

Not to be drawn

(2) IBM modulus 10 check No. of Input Digits

Min. 2 digits Input Data

To be checked as IBM modulus 10 Max. 15 digits

(including C/D) Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9

1 digit 16 digits or more

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of IBM modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 14 digits Drawing

Data

Affix IBM modulus 10.

15 digits or more

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 C/DD9D6

Not to be drawn

(4) IBM modulus 10 + Auto affix of IBM modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 13 digits Drawing

Data

Affix IBM modulus 10. Affix IBM modulus 10.

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 C/D2C/D1D9D6

14 digits or more Not to be drawn

(5) IBM modulus 11 + Auto affix of IBM modulus 10 No. of Input Digits

Input Data

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

Max. 13 digits Drawing

Data

Affix IBM modulus 10. Affix IBM modulus 11.

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 C/D2C/D1D9D6

14 digits or more Not to be drawn

- 301 -

Page 306: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: Interleaved 2 of 5

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Max. 126 digits

Input Data

Not recognized as a check digit.

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10 D8 D9

127 digits or more Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 10 check

No. of Input Digits

Min. 2 digits Max. 126 digits

To be checked as modulus 10 C/D

Input Data

(including C/D) Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

D7D6D5D4D3D2D10 D8 D9

1 digit 127 digits or more

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 125 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 10 C/D.

126 digits or more Not to be drawn

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D9D6 C/D

(4) Auto affix of DBP modulus 10

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 125 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a DBP modulus 10 C/D.

126 digits or more

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 C/DD9D6

Not to be drawn

- 302 -

Page 307: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: Industrial 2 of 5

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Max. 126 digits

Input Data

Not recognized as a check digit.

Drawing

Data

127 digits or more Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus check character check

No. of Input Digits

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D8 D9

Min. 2 digits Max. 126 digits

Input Data

To be checked as a modulus check character

(including C/D) Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D8 D9

1 digit 127 digits or more

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus check character

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 125 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus check character.

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8

D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 C/DD9D6

126 digits or more Not to be drawn

- 303 -

Page 308: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: CODE39 (Standard)

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Max. 123 digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code Not recognized as a check digit.

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

124 digits or more Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 43 check

No. of Input Digits

Min. 2 digits Max. 123 digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code To be checked as modulus 43 C/D

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

(including C/D) Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

1 digit 124 digits or more

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 43

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code

Max. 122 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 43 C/D.

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 C/D SpD9

123 digits or more Not to be drawn

- 304 -

Page 309: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: CODE39 (Full ASCII)

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code Not recognized as a check digit. Max. 60 digits

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

61 digits or more Not to be drawn

(2) Modulus 43 check

No. of Input Digits

Min. 2 digits Max. 60 digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code To be checked as modulus 43 C/D

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

(including C/D) Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

1 digit 61 digits or more

Not to be drawn

(3) Auto affix of modulus 43

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code

Max. 60 digits Drawing

Data

Affix a modulus 43 C/D. 61 digits or more Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 SpD9

NOTE: Numerals under bars are not characters corresponding to the bars but the characters of the codes received are drawn.

Type of Bar Code: NW7

(1) No affix C/D check Auto affix

No. of Input Digits

Max. 125 digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code

Drawing

Data

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 C/D SpD9

126 digits or more Not to be drawn

D8D7D6D5D4St D1 D2 D3 D9 Sp

D8D7D6D5D4St D1 D2 D3 D9 Sp

- 305 -

Page 310: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: No auto selection of CODE128 (Character “>” to be also counted as a digit)

(1) No affix PSEUDO103 check Auto affix of PSEUDO103

No. of Input Digits

Min. 3 digits Max. 125 digits

Input Data

(including start code) Drawing

Data

Affix PSEUDO103 C/D.

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 D10 D11D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 D10D9 D11

C/D Sp

2 digits or less 126 digits or more

Not to be drawn

NOTE: The following characters are not drawn as numerals under bars. NUL (00H) to US (1FH), FNC1, FNC2, FNC3, SHIFT, CODE A, CODE B, CODE C

Type of Bar Code: Auto selection of CODE128

(1) No affix C/D check Auto affix of C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 60 digits Drawing

Data

Stop code Start code Selection code Affix

PSEUDO103 C/D.

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9 D10 D11

D4D3D2St D1 D8 C/D ADD7D6D5 D9AD D10 D11 Sp

61 digits or more Not to be drawn

NOTE: The following characters are not drawn as numerals under bars. NUL (00H) to US (1FH), FNC1, FNC2, FNC3, SHIFT, CODE A, CODE B, CODE C

- 306 -

Page 311: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: CODE93

(1) No affix C/D check Auto affix of C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Max. 60 digits Drawing

Data

Stop code Affix a modulus 47 “K” C/D. Start code Affix a modulus 47 “C” C/D.

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2D1 D9

D8D7D6D5D4D3D2St D1 Sp C/D2C/D1D9

61 digits or more Not to be drawn

NOTE: Numerals under bars are not characters corresponding to the bars but the characters of the codes received are drawn.

Type of Bar Code: UCC/EAN128

(1) No affix C/D check Auto affix of C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

19 digits

Drawing Data

Start code Affix a modulus 10 C/D. Affix a modulus 11 C/D. Stop code

Other than 19 digits Not to be drawn

---

---

D6D5D4D3D2D1 D14 D15 D16 D17 D18 D19

D4D3D2St D14D1 D15D6 D16D5 D17FNC1 D18 C/D2C/D1D19 Sp

- 307 -

Page 312: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: POSTNET

(1) Auto affix of dedicated C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

5 digits Drawing

Data

Start code Stop code Dedicated check digit

D5D4D3D2D1

SpC/DD5D4D3D2D1St

Input Data

9 digits Start code Stop code

Drawing Data

Dedicated check digit

D5D4D3D2D1

SpC/DD5D4D3D2D1St

D9D8D7D6

D9D8D7D6

Input Data

11 digits

Drawing Data

Start code Frame Frame Stop code Dedicated check digit

Other than 5, 9, and 11 digits

D5D4D3D2D1 D9D8D7D6 D11D10

D4 C/DD5D3D2D1St Sp Fr D9 D11D10D8D7D6 C/D Fr

Not to be drawn

Type of Bar Code: RM4SCC

(1) Auto affix of dedicated C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

Start code Stop code

12 digits Drawing

Data

Start code Stop code Dedicated check digit

13 digits or more Not to be drawn

Type of Bar Code: KIX CODE

(1) No affix

No. of Input Digits

18 digits

Input Data

Drawing Data

19 digits or more Not to be drawn

D4D3D2D1(St) D8 D11 (Sp) D5 D6 D7 D9 D10 D12

D5D4D3D2D1St Sp C/D D6 D9D8D7 D10 D11 D12

D4D3D2D1 D8D7D6D5 D10D9 D11 D12 D14D13 D16D15 D17 D18

D4D3D2D1 D8D7D6D5 D10D9 D11 D12 D14D13 D16D15 D17 D18

- 308 -

Page 313: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code: Customer bar code

(1) Auto affix of dedicated C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

20 digits

Drawing Data Start code Dedicated check digit

Stop code

D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9D8D7D6 D15D14D13D12D11 D20D19D18D17D16

D4D3D2D1St D9D8D7D6D5 D14D13D12D11D10 D19D18D17D16D15 SpC/DD20

21 digits or more Data of up to 20 digits is drawn. Data of 21 digits or more is discarded.

Type of Bar Code: Highest priority customer bar code

(1) Auto affix of dedicated C/D

No. of Input Digits

Input Data

19 digits

Drawing Data

Start code CC7 Dedicated check digit Stop code

D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9D8D7D6 D15D14D13D12D11 D19D18D17D16

D4D3D2D1St D9D8D7D6D5 D14D13D12D11D10 D19 SpC/DCC7D18D17D16D15

20 digits or more Data of up to 19 digits is drawn. Data of 20 digits or more is discarded.

Type of Bar Code: RSS-14, RSS-14 Stacked, RSS-14 Stacked Omnidirectional, RSS Limited

(1) Auto affix of dedicated C/D

No. of Input Digits

13 digits

Input Data

Drawing Data

Dedicated check digit

14 digits or more Not to be drawn

Type of Bar Code: RSS Expanded

(1) Auto affix of dedicated C/D

No. of Input Digits

70 digits

Input Data

Drawing Data

Dedicated check digit

71 digits or more Not to be drawn NOTE: Some data cannot be drawn even if the number of input digits is less than 70.

D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9D8D7D6 D13D12D11

C/DD5D4D3D2D1 D10D9D8D7D6 D13D12D11

D5D4D3D2D1 D10D9D8D7D6 D13D12D11

C/DD5D4D3D2D1 D10D9D8D7D6 D13D12D11

- 309 -

Page 314: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

15. AUTOMATIC ADDITION OF START/STOP CODES

Type of Bar Code Designation of Start/Stop Codes Input Data Drawing Data

12345ABC Standard *12345ABC* Full ASCII *12345ABC* *12345ABC Standard *12345ABC* Full ASCII *12345ABC* 12345ABC* Standard *12345ABC* Full ASCII *12345ABC* *12345ABC* Standard *12345ABC* Omit Full ASCII *12345ABC* (No designation) 12345*ABC Standard *12345*ABC* Full ASCII *12345/JABC* **12345ABC Standard **12345ABC* Full ASCII */J12345ABC* *12345ABC** Standard *12345ABC** Full ASCII *12345ABC/J* *12345*ABC* Standard *12345*ABC* Full ASCII *12345/JABC* 12345ABC Standard *12345ABC Full ASCII *12345ABC *12345ABC Standard **12345ABC Full ASCII */J12345ABC 12345ABC* Standard *12345ABC* Full ASCII *12345ABC* *12345ABC* Standard **12345ABC*

CODE 39 Add start code Full ASCII */J12345ABC* 12345*ABC Standard *12345*ABC Full ASCII *12345/JABC **12345ABC Standard ***12345ABC Full ASCII */J/J12345ABC *12345ABC** Standard **12345ABC** Full ASCII */J12345ABC/J* *12345*ABC* Standard **12345*ABC* Full ASCII */J12345/JABC* 12345ABC Standard 12345ABC* Full ASCII 12345ABC* *12345ABC Standard *12345ABC* Full ASCII *12345ABC* 12345ABC* Standard 12345ABC** Full ASCII 12345ABC/J* Add stop code *12345ABC* Standard *12345ABC** Full ASCII *12345ABC/J* 12345*ABC Standard 12345*ABC* Full ASCII 12345/JABC* **12345ABC Standard **12345ABC* Full ASCII */J12345ABC* *12345ABC** Standard *12345ABC*** Full ASCII *12345ABC/J/J* *12345*ABC* Standard *12345*ABC** Full ASCII *12345/JABC/J*

- 310 -

Page 315: TOSHIBA Bar Code Printer B-SA4T Seriesprintmark.de/downloads/prog_manuals/Prog_handb_B_SA4T.pdf• Logic 1 is a Low level, while logic 0 is a High level. • It is in the Low (Mark)

Type of Bar Code Designation of

Start/Stop Codes Input Data Drawing Data

12345ABC Standard 12345ABC Full ASCII 12345ABC *12345ABC Standard *12345ABC Full ASCII *12345ABC 12345ABC* Standard 12345ABC* Full ASCII 12345ABC* *12345ABC* Standard *12345ABC*

CODE 39 Start/stop code Full ASCII *12345ABC* not added 12345*ABC Standard 12345*ABC Full ASCII 12345/JABC **12345ABC Standard **12345ABC Full ASCII */J12345ABC *12345ABC** Standard *12345ABC** Full ASCII *12345ABC/J* *12345*ABC* Standard *12345*ABC* Full ASCII *12345/JABC*

Type of Bar Code Designation of

Start/Stop Codes Input Data Drawing Data

12345678 a12345678a a12345678 a12345678 12345678c 12345678c Omit b12345678d b12345678d (No designation) 12345a678 a12345a678a ab12345678 ab12345678 a12345678bc a12345678bc d12345b678c d12345b678c 12345678 a12345678 a12345678 aa12345678 12345678c a12345678c Add start code b12345678d ab12345678d 12345a678 a12345a678 ab12345678 aab12345678 a12345678bc aa12345678bc d12345b678c ad12345b678c

NW7 12345678 12345678a a12345678 a12345678a 12345678c 12345678ca b12345678d b12345678da Add stop code 12345a678 12345a678a ab12345678 ab12345678a a12345678bc a12345678bca d12345b678c d12345b678ca 12345678 12345678 a12345678 a12345678 12345678c 12345678c Start/stop code b12345678d b12345678d not added 12345a678 12345a678 ab12345678 ab12345678 a12345678bc a12345678bc d12345b678c d12345b678c

- 311 -